cbna10k2014.htm

UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
 Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-K
 
  x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
  For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014
   
  o TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
  For the transition period from                     to                                       
  Commission file number 001-13695
 
 
 
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
 
                                       Delaware                                                              16-1213679                 
 (State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)      (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
     
         5790 Widewaters Parkway, DeWitt, New York                                  13214-1883                  
 (Address of principal executive offices)    (Zip Code)
   (315) 445-2282  
(Registrant's telephone number, including area code)
 
Securities registered pursuant of Section 12(b) of the Act:
                                   Title of each class                                        Name of each exchange on which registered      
Common Stock, Par Value $1.00 per share   New York Stock Exchange
 
 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  Yes  x    No  o.
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.  Yes  o    No  x .
 
 Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act
 of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject
 to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.   Yes   x    No  o.
 
 Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Website, if any, every Interactive Data
 File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or
 for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).   Yes  x   No  o.
 
 Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§229.405 of this chapter) is not contained
 herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by
 reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment of this Form 10-K.  o.
 
 Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting
 company.  See definition of “large accelerated filer”, “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 Large accelerated filer   x  Accelerated filer  o  Non-accelerated filer  o  Smaller reporting company  o.
    (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)  
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).  Yes  o  No  x  .
 
 The aggregate market value of the common stock, $1.00 par value per share, held by non-affiliates of the registrant computed by reference to the closing
 price as of the close of business on June 30, 2014 (the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter): $1,406,975,318.
 
The number of shares of the common stock, $1.00 par value per share, outstanding as of the close of business on January 31, 2015: 40,792,708 shares
 
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE.
 
 Portions of the Definitive Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of the Shareholders to be held on May 20, 2015 (the "Proxy Statement")
 is incorporated by reference in Part III of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.


 
1

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

PART I
 
Page
Item 1
Business____________________________________________________________________________________________________________
     3
Item 1A
Risk Factors _________________________________________________________________________________________________________  
11
Item 1B
Unresolved Staff Comments _____________________________________________________________________________________________
15
Item 2
Properties___________________________________________________________________________________________________________
16
Item 3
Legal Proceedings____________________________________________________________________________________________________
16
Item 4
Mine Safety Disclosures________________________________________________________________________________________________
16
Item 4A.
Executive Officers of the Registrant_______________________________________________________________________________________
17
     
PART II
   
Item 5
Market for Registrant's Common Equity, Related Stockholders Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities_____________________________
17
Item 6
Selected Financial Data_________________________________________________________________________________________________
19
Item 7
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations______________________________________________
21
Item 7A
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk_____________________________________________________________________
48
Item 8
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data:
 
 
     Consolidated Statements of Condition____________________________________________________________________________________
50
 
     Consolidated Statements of Income______________________________________________________________________________________
51
 
     Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income_________________________________________________________________________
52
 
     Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders' Equity__________________________________________________________________
53
 
     Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows__________________________________________________________________________________
54
 
     Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements_______________________________________________________________________________
55
 
     Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting_________________________________________________________________________
91
 
     Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm____________________________________________________________________
92
 
Two Year Selected Quarterly Data_________________________________________________________________________________________
93
Item 9
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure______________________________________________
93
Item 9A.
Controls and Procedures________________________________________________________________________________________________
93
Item 9B.
Other Information_____________________________________________________________________________________________________
94
     
PART III
   
Item 10
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance________________________________________________________________________
94
Item 11
Executive Compensation________________________________________________________________________________________________
94
Item 12
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters______________________________________
94
Item 13
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence_________________________________________________________
94
Item 14
Principal Accounting Fees and Services____________________________________________________________________________________
94
     
PART IV
   
Item 15
Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules____________________________________________________________________________________
95
Signatures
__________________________________________________________________________________________________________________
99
     
     
     
     
     
     
     







 
2

 

Part I

This Annual Report on Form 10-K contains certain forward-looking statements with respect to the financial condition, results of operations and business of Community Bank System, Inc.  These forward-looking statements by their nature address matters that involve certain risks and uncertainties.  Factors that may cause actual results to differ materially from those contemplated by such forward-looking statements are set forth herein under the caption “Forward-Looking Statements.”

Item 1. Business

Community Bank System, Inc. (the “Company”) was incorporated on April 15, 1983, under the Delaware General Corporation Law.  Its principal office is located at 5790 Widewaters Parkway, DeWitt, New York 13214.  The Company is a single bank holding company which wholly-owns five subsidiaries: Community Bank, N.A. (the “Bank” or “CBNA”), Benefit Plans Administrative Services, Inc. (“BPAS”), CFSI Closeout Corp. (“CFSICC”), First of Jermyn Realty Company, Inc. (“FJRC”) and Town & Country Agency LLC (“T&C”).  BPAS owns four subsidiaries: Benefit Plans Administrative Services, LLC (“BPA”), a provider of defined contribution plan administration services; Harbridge Consulting Group, LLC (“Harbridge”), a provider of actuarial and benefit consulting services; BPAS Trust Company of Puerto Rico, a Puerto Rican trust company; and Hand Benefits & Trust Company (“HB&T”), a provider of collective investment fund administration and institutional trust services.  HB&T owns one subsidiary, Hand Securities, Inc. (“HSI”), an introducing broker dealer.  CFSICC, FJRC and T&C are inactive companies.  The Company also wholly-owns two unconsolidated subsidiary business trusts formed for the purpose of issuing mandatorily-redeemable preferred securities which are considered Tier I capital under regulatory capital adequacy guidelines. 

The Bank’s business philosophy is to operate as a community bank with local decision-making, principally in non-metropolitan markets, providing a broad array of banking and financial services to retail, commercial, and municipal customers.  As of December 31, 2014, the Bank operates 182 full-service branches operating as Community Bank, N.A. throughout 35 counties of Upstate New York and six counties of Northeastern Pennsylvania, offering a range of commercial and retail banking services.  The Bank owns the following subsidiaries: CBNA Insurance Agency, Inc. (“CBNA Insurance”), CBNA Preferred Funding Corporation (“PFC”), CBNA Treasury Management Corporation (“TMC”), Community Investment Services, Inc. (“CISI”), First Liberty Service Corp. (“FLSC”), Nottingham Advisors, Inc. (“Nottingham”), Brilie Corporation (“Brilie”), and Western Catskill Realty, LLC (“WCR”).  CBNA Insurance is a full-service insurance agency offering primarily property and casualty products.  PFC primarily acts as an investor in residential real estate loans.  TMC provides cash management, investment, and treasury services to the Bank.  CISI provides broker-dealer and investment advisory services.  FLSC provides banking-related services to the Pennsylvania branches of the Bank.  Nottingham provides asset management services to individuals, corporations, corporate pension and profit sharing plans, and foundations.  Brilie and WCR are inactive companies.

The Company maintains a website at communitybankna.com.  Annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports, are available on the Company’s website free of charge as soon as reasonably practicable after such reports or amendments are electronically filed with or furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”).  The information posted on the website is not incorporated into or a part of this filing.  Copies of all documents filed with the SEC can also be obtained by visiting the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC  20549, by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 or by accessing the SEC’s website at http://www.sec.gov.
 
On February 24, 2015, the Company announced that it had entered into a definitive agreement to acquire Oneida Financial Corp. (“Oneida”), parent company of Oneida Savings Bank headquartered in Oneida, NY for approximately $142 million in Company stock and cash.  The acquisition will extend the Company’s Central New York banking service area and complement the Company’s existing non-banking service capacity in the insurance, benefits administration and wealth management businesses.  Upon the completion of the merger, Community Bank will add 12 branch locations and approximately $800 million of assets, including loans of $370 million and $690 million of deposits.  The acquisition is expected to close during the third quarter of 2015, pending both customary regulatory and Oneida shareholder approval.  The Company expects to incur certain one-time, transaction-related costs in 2015.
 
Acquisition History (2010-2014)

EBS-RMSCO, Inc.
On January 1, 2014, the Company, through its Harbridge subsidiary, completed its acquisition of a professional services practice from EBS-RMSCO, Inc., a subsidiary of The Lifetime Healthcare Companies (“EBS-RMSCO”).  This professional services practice, which provides actuarial valuation and consulting services to clients who sponsor pension and post-retirement medical and welfare plans, enhances the Company’s participation in the Western New York market and added $1.2 million of incremental revenue in 2014.

 
3

 


Bank of America Branches
On December 13, 2013,  the Bank completed its acquisition of eight retail branch-banking locations across its Northeast Pennsylvania markets from Bank of America, N.A. (“B of A”), acquiring approximately $0.9 million in loans and $303 million of deposits.  The assumed deposits consist of $220 million of core deposits (checking, savings and money market accounts) and $83 million of time deposits.  Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the Bank paid B of A a blended deposit premium of 2.4%, or approximately $7.3 million.
 
HSBC and First Niagara Branches
On July 20, 2012,  the Bank completed its acquisition of 16 retail branches in central, northern and western New York from HSBC Bank USA, N.A. (“HSBC”), acquiring approximately $106 million in loans and $697 million of deposits.  The assumed deposits consist primarily of core deposits (checking, savings and money market accounts) and the purchased loans consist of in-market performing loans, primarily residential real estate loans.  Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the Bank paid First Niagara Bank, N.A. (“First Niagara”) (who acquired HSBC’s Upstate New York banking business and assigned its right to purchase the 16 branches to the Bank) a blended deposit premium of 3.4%, or approximately $24 million.
 
On September 7, 2012, the Bank completed its acquisition of three branches in central New York from First Niagara, acquiring approximately $54 million of loans and $101 million of deposits.  The assumed deposits consist primarily of core deposits (checking, savings and money market accounts) and the purchased loans consist of in-market performing loans, primarily residential real estate loans. Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the Bank paid a blended deposit premium of 3.1%, or approximately $3 million.

CAI Benefits, Inc.
On November 30, 2011, BPAS acquired, in an all-cash transaction, certain assets and liabilities of CAI Benefits, Inc. (“CAI”), a provider of actuarial, consulting and retirement plan administration services, with offices in New York City and Northern New Jersey.  The transaction added valuable service capacity and enhances distribution prospects in support of the Company’s broader-based employee benefits business, including daily valuation plan and collective investment fund administration.

The Wilber Corporation
On April 8, 2011, the Company acquired The Wilber Corporation, parent company of Wilber National Bank, and its 22 branch-banking centers in the Central, Greater Capital District and Catskill regions of New York for $103 million of stock and cash.  The Company acquired approximately $462 million in loans, $297 million of investment securities and $772 million in deposits.

Services

Banking
The Bank is a community bank committed to the philosophy of serving the financial needs of customers in local communities.  The Bank's branches are generally located in smaller towns and cities within its geograph­ic market areas of Upstate New York and Northeastern Pennsylvania. The Company believes that the local character of its business, knowledge of the customers and their needs, and its comprehensive retail and business products, together with responsive decision-making at the branch and regional levels, enable the Bank to compete effectively in its geographic market.   The Bank is a member of the Federal Reserve System and the Federal Home Loan Bank of New York ("FHLB"), and its deposits are insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) up to applicable limits.

Employee Benefit Services
Through BPAS and its subsidiaries, the Company operates a national practice that provides employee benefit trust, collective investment fund, retirement plan administration, actuarial, VEBA/HRA and health and welfare consulting services to a diverse array of clients spanning the United States and Puerto Rico.

Wealth Management
Through the Bank, CISI, Nottingham and CBNA Insurance, the Company operates a wealth management, retirement planning, higher educational planning, fiduciary, risk management, and wealth protection business.  Through a third party broker-dealer relationship, the Company offers investment alternatives including stocks, bonds, mutual funds and advisory products.

Segment Information

The Company has identified three operating business segments:  Banking, Employee Benefit Services, and Wealth Management.  Information about the Company’s business segments is included in Note T of the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements” filed herewith in Part II.
 
 
4

 
 
Competition

The banking and financial services industry is highly competitive in the New York and Pennsylvania markets.  The Company competes actively for loans, deposits and customers with other national and state banks, thrift institutions, credit unions, retail brokerage firms, mortgage bankers, finance companies, insurance companies, and other regulated and unregulated providers of financial services.  In order to compete with other financial service providers, the Company stresses the community nature of its operations and the development of profitable customer relationships across all lines of business.

The table below summarizes the Bank’s deposits and market share by the forty-one counties of New York and Pennsylvania in which it has customer facilities.  Market share is based on deposits of all commercial banks, credit unions, savings and loan associations, and savings banks.

       
Number of
             
Towns Where
   
Deposits as of
       
Company
   
 6/30/2014(1)
Market
   
Towns/
Has 1st or 2nd
County
State
(000's omitted)
Share (1)
Branches
ATM's
Cities
Market Position
Lewis
NY
$164,915
72.03%
4
4
3
3
Franklin
NY
233,642
56.94%
8
6
6
6
Hamilton
NY
50,677
55.01%
2
2
2
2
Allegany
NY
249,209
51.31%
9
10
8
8
Cattaraugus
NY
387,929
42.90%
10
11
7
6
Seneca
NY
219,590
39.20%
4
3
4
3
Otsego
NY
355,218
36.67%
10
10
6
5
St. Lawrence
NY
399,003
36.40%
12
9
11
10
Schuyler
NY
49,715
27.55%
1
1
1
1
Clinton
NY
333,606
26.87%
4
7
2
2
Jefferson
NY
366,379
26.60%
7
9
6
6
Yates
NY
86,885
26.07%
3
2
2
1
Wyoming
PA
128,849
25.99%
4
4
3
3
Chautauqua
NY
316,539
21.99%
13
12
11
8
Essex
NY
135,816
21.73%
5
5
4
4
Livingston
NY
164,112
20.40%
5
6
5
4
Steuben
NY
180,604
19.67%
8
7
7
4
Delaware
NY
163,535
17.07%
5
5
5
5
Wayne
NY
126,234
16.17%
3
3
2
2
Ontario
NY
234,970
13.23%
8
13
5
3
Oswego
NY
162,122
12.89%
4
5
4
3
Tioga
NY
35,906
9.07%
2
2
2
1
Lackawanna
PA
412,446
7.97%
12
11
8
4
Luzerne
PA
456,629
7.83%
11
15
8
3
Herkimer
NY
43,828
7.58%
1
1
1
1
Chemung
NY
74,810
7.22%
2
2
1
0
Susquehanna
PA
51,458
6.80%
3
1
3
2
Schoharie
NY
25,636
6.29%
1
1
1
0
Carbon
PA
43,205
4.86%
2
2
2
1
Bradford
PA
49,027
4.32%
2
2
2
1
Cayuga
NY
40,735
3.98%
2
2
2
1
Chenango
NY
28,510
3.72%
2
2
1
1
Washington
NY
18,156
2.65%
1
0
1
1
Warren
NY
32,205
2.19%
1
1
1
1
Oneida
NY
58,214
1.86%
1
1
1
1
Broome
NY
28,753
1.21%
1
1
1
0
Ulster
NY
25,757
0.76%
1
1
1
1
Onondaga
NY
30,395
0.34%
2
4
2
0
Erie
NY
102,663
0.30%
4
4
3
2
Tompkins
NY
4,772
0.27%
1
0
1
0
Saratoga
NY
7,256
0.20%
1
1
1
0
   
$6,079,910
6.46%
182
188
147
110
               
 (1) Deposits and Market Share data as of June 30, 2014, the most recent information available from
      SNL Financial LLC, adjusted for branch consolidations occurring after June 30, 2014.
 

 

 
5

 
 
Employees

As of December 31, 2014, the Company employed 1,920 full-time employees, 136 part-time employees and 126 temporary employees.  None of the Company’s employees are represented by a collective bargaining agreement.  The Company offers a variety of employment benefits and considers its relationship with its employees to be good.

Supervision and Regulation

General

The banking industry is highly regulated with numerous statutory and regulatory requirements that are designed primarily for the protection of depositors and the financial system, and not for the purpose of protecting shareholders.  Set forth below is a description of the material information governing the laws and regulations applicable to the Company and the Bank.  This summary is not complete and the reader should refer to these laws and regulations for more detailed information.  The Company’s and the Bank’s failure to comply with applicable laws and regulations could result in a range of sanctions and administrative actions imposed upon the Company and/or the Bank, including the imposition of civil money penalties, formal agreements and cease and desist orders.  Changes in applicable law or regulations, and in their interpretation and application by regulatory agencies, cannot be predicted, and may have a material effect on the Company’s business and results.

The Company and its subsidiaries are subject to the laws and regulations of the federal government and the states and jurisdictions in which they conduct business.  The Company, as a bank holding company, is subject to extensive regulation, supervision and examination by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (“FRB”) as its primary federal regulator.  The Bank is a nationally-chartered bank and is subject to extensive regulation, supervision and examination by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) as its primary federal regulator, and as to certain matters, the FRB, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (“CFPB”), and the FDIC.

The Company is also subject to the jurisdiction of the SEC and is subject to disclosure and regulatory requirement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.  The Company’s common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) and it is subject to NYSE’s rules for listed companies.  Affiliated entities, including BPAS, HB&T, HSI, BPAS Trust Company of Puerto Rico, Nottingham, CISI, HSI and CBNA Insurance are subject to the jurisdiction of certain state and federal regulators and self-regulatory organizations including, but not limited to, the SEC, the Texas Department of Banking, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (“FINRA”), Puerto Rico Office of the Commissioner of Financial Institutions, and state securities and insurance regulators.

Federal Bank Holding Company Regulation
The Company is registered as a bank holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the “BHC Act”).  The BHC Act limits the type of activities in which the Company and its subsidiaries may engage and the types of companies it may acquire or organize.  In general, the Company and the Bank are prohibited from engaging in or acquiring direct or indirect control of any entity engaged in non-banking activities unless such activities are closely related to banking, as determined by the BHC Act.  In addition, the Company must obtain the prior approval of the FRB to acquire control of any bank; to acquire, with certain exceptions, more than five percent of the outstanding voting stock of any other entity; or to merge or consolidate with another bank holding company.  As a result of such laws and regulation, the Company is restricted as to the types of business activities it may conduct and the Bank is subject to limitations on, among others, the types of loans and the amounts of loans it may make to any one borrower.  The Financial Modernization Act of 1999 (also known as the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act (the “GLB Act”)) created, among other things, the “financial holding company,” an entity which may engage in a broader range of activities that are “financial in nature,” including insurance underwriting, securities underwriting and merchant banking.  Bank holding companies which are well capitalized and well managed under regulatory standards may convert to financial holding companies relatively easily through a notice filing with the FRB, which acts as the “umbrella regulator” for such entities.  The Company may seek to become a financial holding company in the future.

Federal Reserve System Regulation
Because the Company is a bank holding company it is subject to regulatory capital requirements and required by the FRB to, among other things, maintain cash reserves against its deposits.  The Bank is under similar capital requirements administered by the OCC as discussed below.  FRB policy has historically required a bank holding company to act as a source of financial and managerial strength to its subsidiary banks.  The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) codifies this historical policy as a statutory requirement.  To the extent the Bank is in need of capital, the Company could be expected to provide additional capital, including borrowings from the FRB for such purpose.  Both the Company and the Bank are subject to extensive supervision and regulation, which focus on, among other things, the protection of depositors’ funds.
 

 
 
6

 

The FRB has established minimum capital requirements for the Company and the Bank.  The FRB capital adequacy guidelines apply on a consolidated basis and require bank holding companies to maintain a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to total average assets (or “leverage ratio”) of 4%.  The FRB capital adequacy guidelines also require bank holding companies to maintain a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 4% and a minimum ratio of qualifying total capital to risk-weighted assets of 8%.  As of December 31, 2014, the Company’s leverage ratio was 9.96%, its ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets was 17.27%, and its ratio of qualifying total capital to risk-weighted assets was 18.42%.  For additional information on the Company’s capital requirements see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Capital” and Note P to the Financial Statements.  The FRB may set higher minimum capital requirements for bank holding companies whose circumstances warrant it, such as companies anticipating significant growth or facing unusual risks.  Any holding company whose capital does not meet the minimum capital adequacy guidelines is considered to be undercapitalized and is required to submit an acceptable plan to the FRB for achieving capital adequacy.  Such a company’s ability to pay dividends to its shareholders and expand its lines of business through the acquisition of new banking or nonbanking subsidiaries also could be restricted.

The FRB also regulates the national supply of bank credit in order to influence general economic conditions.  These policies have a significant influence on overall growth and distribution of loans, investments and deposits, and affect the interest rates charged on loans or paid for deposits.

Fluctuations in interest rates, which may result from government fiscal policies and the monetary policies of the FRB, have a strong impact on the income derived from loans and securities, and interest paid on deposits and borrowings.  While the Company and the Bank strive to model various interest rate changes and adjust our strategies for such changes, the level of earnings can be materially affected by economic circumstances beyond their control.

The Office of Comptroller of the Currency Regulation
The Bank is supervised and regularly examined by the OCC.  The various laws and regulations administered by the OCC affect the Company’s practices such as payment of dividends, incurring debt, and acquisition of financial institutions and other companies.  It also affects the Bank’s business practices, such as payment of interest on deposits, the charging of interest on loans, types of business conducted and the location of its offices.  The OCC generally prohibits a depository institution from making any capital distributions, including the payment of a dividend, or paying any management fee to its parent holding company if the depository institution would become undercapitalized due to the payment.  Undercapitalized institutions are subject to growth limitations and are required to submit a capital restoration plan to the OCC.  The Bank is well capitalized under regulatory standards administered by the OCC.  For additional information on our capital requirements see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Capital” and Note P to the Financial Statements.

Federal Home Loan Bank
The Bank is a member of the FHLB, which provides a central credit facility primarily for member institutions for home mortgage and neighborhood lending.  The Bank is subject to the rules and requirements of the FHLB, including the purchase of shares of FHLB activity-based stock in the amount of 4.5% of the dollar amount of outstanding advances and FHLB capital stock in an amount equal to the greater of $1,000 or the sum of 0.15% of the mortgage-related assets held by the Bank based upon the previous year-end financial information.  The Bank was in compliance with the rules and requirements of the FHLB at December 31, 2014.

Deposit Insurance
Substantially all of the deposits of the Bank are insured up to applicable limits by the Deposit Insurance Fund (“DIF”) and are subject to deposit insurance assessments to maintain the DIF.  The Dodd-Frank Act permanently increased the maximum amount of deposit insurance to $250,000 per deposit category, per depositor, per institution retroactive to January 1, 2008.  On April 1, 2011, the deposit insurance assessment base changed from total domestic deposits to the average consolidated total assets minus the average tangible equity of the depository institution, pursuant to a rule issued by the FDIC as required by the Dodd-Frank Act.  Additionally, the deposit insurance assessment system was revised to create a two scorecard system, one for most large institutions that have more than $10 billion in assets and another for “highly complex” institutions that have over $50 billion in assets and are fully owned by a parent with over $500 billion in assets.  The Bank is not affected by the two scorecard system as total assets are below the minimum threshold.
 
In October 2010, the FDIC adopted a DIF restoration plan to ensure that the fund reserve ratio reaches 1.35% by September 30, 2020, as required by the Dodd-Frank Act.  At least semi-annually, the FDIC will update its loss and income projections for the fund and, if needed, will increase or decrease assessment rates, following notice-and-comment rulemaking if required.  FDIC insurance expense totaled $3.9 million, $3.8 million and $3.8 million in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
 
Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, if the FDIC finds that an institution has engaged in unsafe and unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations, or has violated any applicable law, regulation, rule, order or condition imposed by the FDIC, the FDIC may determine that such violation or unsafe or unsound practice or condition require the termination of deposit insurance.
 
 
 
7

 
 
Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010
On July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Act was signed into law, which resulted in significant changes to the banking industry.  The provisions that have received the most public attention have been those that apply to financial institutions larger than the Company; however, the Dodd-Frank Act does contain numerous other provisions that affect all banks and bank holding companies and impacts how the Company and the Bank handle their operations.  The Dodd-Frank Act requires various federal agencies, including those that regulate the Company and the Bank, to promulgate new rules and regulations and to conduct various studies and reports for Congress.  The federal agencies are in the process of promulgating these rules and regulations and have been given significant discretion in drafting such rules and regulations.  Several of the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act may have the consequence of increasing the Bank’s expenses, decreasing its revenues, and changing the activities in which it chooses to engage.  The specific impact of the Dodd-Frank Act on the Company’s current activities or new financial activities the Company may consider in the future, the Company’s financial performance, and the markets in which the Company operates depends on the manner in which the relevant agencies continue to develop and implement the required rules and regulations and the reaction of market participants to these regulatory developments.

The Dodd-Frank Act includes provisions that, among other things applies the same leverage and risk-based capital requirements that apply to insured depository institutions to most bank holding companies, which, among other things as applied to the Company, going forward will preclude the Company from including in Tier 1 Capital trust preferred securities or cumulative preferred stock, if any, issued on or after May 19, 2010.  The Company has not issued any trust preferred securities since May 19, 2010.

Pursuant to FRB regulations mandated by the Dodd-Frank Act, effective October 1, 2011, interchange fees on debit card transactions are limited to a maximum of $.21 per transaction plus 5 basis points of the transaction amount.  A debit card issuer may recover an additional one cent per transaction for fraud prevention purposes if the issuer complies with certain fraud-related requirements prescribed by the FRB.  Issuers that, together with their affiliates, have less than $10 billion in assets, such as the Company, are exempt from the debit card interchange fee standards.  The FRB also adopted requirements in the final rule that issuers include two unaffiliated networks for routing debit transactions that are applicable to the Company and the Bank.

On December 10, 2013, the FRB, SEC, OCC, FDIC and Commodity Futures Trading Commission issued the final rules implementing Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act (commonly known as the Volcker Rule) which became effective on April 1, 2014.  The final rules prohibit insured depository institutions and companies affiliated with insured depository institutions from engaging in short-term proprietary trading of certain securities, derivatives, commodity futures and options on these instruments, for their own account.  The final rules also impose limits on banking entities’ investments in, and other relationships with, hedge funds or private equity funds.  Banking entities with less than $10 billion in total consolidated assets, which generally have very little or no involvement in prohibited proprietary trading or investment activities in covered funds, do not have any compliance obligations under the final rule if they do not engage in any covered activities other than trading in certain government, agency, State or municipal obligations.

On February 7, 2012, the CFPB issued the final rules implementing Section 1073 of the Dodd-Frank Act to create a comprehensive new system of consumer protections for remittance transfers sent by consumers in the United States to individuals and businesses in foreign countries.  The final rules became effective on October 28, 2013.  The amendments provide new protections, including disclosure requirements, and error resolution and cancellation rights, to consumers who send remittance transfers to other consumers or businesses in a foreign country.  The Bank has adopted policies and procedures to comply with the final foreign remittance transfer rules.

The scope and impact of many of the Dodd-Frank Act’s provisions will continue to be determined over time as final regulations are issued and become effective.  As a result, the Company cannot predict the ultimate impact of the Dodd-Frank Act on the Company or the Bank at this time, including the extent to which it could increase costs or limit the Company’s ability to pursue business opportunities in an efficient manner, or otherwise adversely affect its business, financial condition and results of operations.  Nor can the Company predict the impact or substance of other future legislation or regulation.  However, it is expected that they at a minimum will increase the Company’s and the Bank’s operating and compliance costs.  As rules and regulations continue to be issued, the Company may need to dedicate additional resources to ensure compliance, which may increase its costs of operations and adversely impact its earnings.

Basel III
In December 2010, the Basel Committee, a group of bank regulatory supervisors from around the world, released its final framework for strengthening international capital and liquidity regulation, now officially identified by the Basel Committee as “Basel III.”  In July 2013, the FRB, FDIC and OCC released the final rules implementing Basel III in the United States.  For community banks with less than $15 billion in assets, the new minimum capital requirements are effective on January 1, 2015 and the capital conservation buffer and deductions from CET1 capital (defined below) phase in over time.
 

 
 
8

 

The Basel III final capital framework, among other things: introduces as a new capital measure “Common Equity Tier 1,” or “CET1,” specifies that Tier 1 capital consists of CET1 and “Additional Tier 1 capital” instruments meeting specified requirements, defines CET1 narrowly by requiring that most adjustments to regulatory capital measures be made to CET1 and not to the other components of capital, and expands the scope of the adjustments as compared to existing regulations.  When fully phased in on January 1, 2019, Basel III requires banks to maintain:

●  
a minimum ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets of at least 4.5 percent, plus a 2.5 percent “capital conservation buffer” (which is added to the 4.5 percent CET1 ratio as that buffer is phased in, effectively resulting in a minimum ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets of at least 7 percent);
●  
a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of at least 6.0 percent, plus the capital conservation buffer (which is added to the 6.0 percent Tier 1 capital ratio as that buffer is phased in, effectively resulting in a minimum Tier 1 capital ratio of 8.5 percent upon full implementation);
●  
a minimum ratio of Total (that is, Tier 1 plus Tier 2) capital to risk-weighted assets of at least 8.0 percent, plus the capital conservation buffer (which is added to the 8.0 percent total capital ratio as that buffer is phased in, effectively resulting in a minimum total capital ratio of 10.5 percent upon full implementation);
●  
as a newly adopted international standard, a minimum leverage ratio of 3.0 percent, calculated as the ratio of Tier 1 capital to balance sheet exposures plus certain off-balance sheet exposures (as the average for each quarter of the month-end ratios for the quarter); and
●  
provides for a “countercyclical capital buffer,” generally to be imposed when national regulators determine that excess aggregate credit growth becomes associated with a buildup of systemic risk, that would be a CET1 add-on to the capital conservation buffer in the range of 0 percent to 2.5 percent when fully implemented (potentially resulting in total buffers of between 2.5 percent and 5 percent).

The capital conservation buffer is designed to absorb losses during periods of economic stress.  Banking institutions with a ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets above the minimum but below the conservation buffer (or below the combined capital conservation buffer and countercyclical capital buffer, when the latter is applied) will face constraints on dividends, equity repurchases and compensation based on the amount of the shortfall.  Banking institutions will be required to meet the following minimum capital ratios based upon the final Basel III rules:
 
●  
4.5 percent CET1 to risk-weighted assets;
  
6.0 percent Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets; and
●  
8.0 percent Total capital to risk-weighted assets.

The Basel III final framework provides for a number of new deductions from and adjustments to CET1.  These include, for example, the requirement that mortgage servicing rights, deferred tax assets and significant investments in non-consolidated financial entities be deducted from CET1 to the extent that any one such category exceeds 10 percent of CET1 or all such categories in the aggregate exceed 15 percent of CET1.  Implementation of the deductions and other adjustments to CET1 will begin on January 1, 2015 and will be phased-in over a five-year period (20 percent per year).  The implementation of the capital conservation buffer will begin on January 1, 2016 at 0.625 percent and be phased in over a four-year period (increasing by that amount on each subsequent January 1, until it reaches 2.5 percent on January 1, 2019).  The Company fully expects to be in compliance with the higher Basel III capital standards as they become effective.

Consumer Protection Laws
In connection with its banking activities, the Bank is subject to a number of federal and state laws designed to protect borrowers and promote lending to various sectors of the economy.  These laws include the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, GLB Act, the Fair Credit Reporting Act (“FCRA”), the Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act of 2003 (“FACT Act”), Electronic Funds Transfer Act, the Truth in Lending Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, the Dodd-Frank Act, the Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act, the Secure and Fair Enforcement for Mortgage Licensing Act (“SAFE”), and various state law counterparts.

The Dodd-Frank Act created the CFPB with broad powers to supervise and enforce consumer protection laws, including laws that apply to banks in order to prohibit unfair, deceptive or abusive practices.  The CFPB has examination authority over all banks and savings institutions with more than $10 billion in assets.  Because the Company is below this threshold, the OCC continues to exercise primary examination authority over the Bank with regard to compliance with federal consumer protection laws and regulations.  The Dodd-Frank Act weakens the federal preemption rules that have been applicable to national banks and gives attorneys general for the states certain powers to enforce federal consumer protection laws.  Further, under the Dodd-Frank Act, it is unlawful for any provider of consumer financial products or services to engage in any unfair, deceptive, or abusive acts or practice (“UDAAP”).  A violation of the consumer protection and privacy laws, and in particular UDAAP, could have serious legal, financial, and reputational consequences.
 

 
 
9

 

In addition, the GLB Act requires all financial institutions to adopt privacy policies, restrict the sharing of nonpublic customer data with nonaffiliated parties and establishes procedures and practices to protect customer data from unauthorized access.  In addition, the FCRA, as amended by the FACT Act, includes provisions affecting the Company, the Bank, and their affiliates, including provisions concerning obtaining consumer reports, furnishing information to consumer reporting agencies, maintaining a program to prevent identity theft, sharing of certain information among affiliated companies, and other provisions.  The FACT Act requires persons subject to FCRA to notify their customers if they report negative information about them to a credit bureau or if they are granted credit on terms less favorable than those generally available.  The FRB and the Federal Trade Commission have extensive rulemaking authority under the FACT Act, and the Company and the Bank are subject to the rules that have been created under the FACT Act, including rules regarding limitations on affiliate marketing and implementation of programs to identify, detect and mitigate certain identity theft red flags.  The Bank is also subject to data security standards and data breach notice requirements issued by the OCC and other regulatory agencies.  The Bank has created policies and procedures to comply with these consumer protection requirements.

On January 10, 2013, the CFPB issued the final rules implementing the ability-to-repay and qualified mortgage (QM) provisions of the Truth in Lending Act, as amended by the Dodd-Frank Act (the “QM Rule”).  The ability-to-repay provision requires creditors to make reasonable, good faith determinations that borrowers are able to repay their mortgages before extending the credit based on a number of factors and consideration of financial information about the borrower derived from reasonably reliable third-party documents. Under the Dodd-Frank Act and the QM Rule, loans meeting the definition of “qualified mortgage” are entitled to a presumption that the lender satisfied the ability-to-repay requirements.  The presumption is a conclusive presumption/safe harbor for loans meeting the QM requirements, and a rebuttable presumption for higher-priced loans meeting the QM requirements.  The definition of a “qualified mortgage” incorporates the statutory requirements, such as not allowing negative amortization or terms longer than 30 years. The QM Rule also adds an explicit maximum 43% debt-to-income ratio for borrowers if the loan is to meet the QM definition, though some mortgages that meet government-sponsored enterprises, Federal Housing Administration, and Veterans Administration underwriting guidelines may, for a period not to exceed seven years, meet the QM definition without being subject to the 43% debt-to-income limits.  The QM Rule became effective on January 10, 2014 and the Bank has created policies and procedures to comply with these consumer protection requirements.

USA Patriot Act
The Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001 (“USA Patriot Act”) imposes obligations on U.S. financial institutions, including banks and broker-dealer subsidiaries, to implement policies, procedures and controls which are reasonably designed to detect and report instances of money laundering and the financing of terrorism.  In addition, provisions of the USA Patriot Act require the federal financial institution regulatory agencies to consider the effectiveness of a financial institution’s anti-money laundering activities when reviewing bank mergers and bank holding company acquisitions.  The USA Patriot Act also encourages information-sharing among financial institutions, regulators, and law enforcement authorities by providing an exemption from the privacy provisions of the GLB Act for financial institutions that comply with the provision of the Act.  Failure of a financial institution to maintain and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing, or to comply with all of the relevant laws or regulations, could have serious legal, financial and reputational consequences for the institution.  The Company has approved policies and procedures that are designed to comply with the USA Patriot Act and its regulations.

Office of Foreign Assets Control Regulation
The United States has imposed economic sanctions that affect transactions with designated foreign countries, nationals and others administrated by the Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control (“OFAC”).  The OFAC administered sanctions can take many different forms depending upon the country; however, they contain one or more of the following elements: (i) restrictions on trade with or investment in a sanctioned country, including prohibitions against direct or indirect imports from and exports to a sanctioned country and prohibitions on “U.S. persons” engaging in financial transactions relating to making investments in, or providing investment related advice or assistance to, a sanctioned country; and (ii) a blocking of assets in which the government or specially designated nationals of the sanctioned country have an interest, by prohibiting transfers of property subject to U.S. jurisdiction (including property in the possession or control of U.S. persons).  Blocked assets (e.g., property and bank deposits) cannot be paid out, withdrawn, set off or transferred in any manner without a license from OFAC.  Failure to comply with these sanctions could have serious legal, financial, and reputational consequences.


 
10

 


Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (“Sarbanes-Oxley Act”) implemented a broad range of corporate governance, accounting and reporting reforms for companies that have securities registered under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.  In particular, the Sarbanes-Oxley Act established, among other things: (i) new requirements for audit and other key Board of Directors committees involving independence, expertise levels, and specified responsibilities; (ii) additional responsibilities regarding the oversight of financial statements by the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer of the reporting company; (iii) the creation of an independent accounting oversight board for the accounting industry; (iv) new standards for auditors and the regulation of audits, including independence provisions which restrict non-audit services that accountants may provide to their audit clients; (v) increased disclosure and reporting obligations for the reporting company and its directors and executive officers including accelerated reporting of company stock transactions; (vi) a prohibition of personal loans to directors and officers, except certain loans made by insured financial institutions on non-preferential terms and in compliance with other bank regulator requirements; and (vii) a range of new and increased civil and criminal penalties for fraud and other violations of the securities laws.

Electronic Fund Transfer Act
Effective July 1, 2010, a federal banking rule under the Electronic Fund Transfer Act prohibits financial institutions from charging consumers fees for paying overdrafts on automated teller machines and one-time debit card transactions, unless a consumer consents, or opts in, to the overdraft service for those types of transactions.  The new rule does not govern overdraft fees on the payment of checks and regular electronic bill payments.  The adoption of this regulation lowered fee income immediately after its effective date.

Community Reinvestment Act of 1977
Under the Community Reinvestment Act of 1977 (“CRA”), the Bank is required to help meet the credit needs of its communities, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods.  Although the Bank must follow the requirements of CRA, it does not limit the Bank’s discretion to develop products and services that are suitable for a particular community or establish lending requirements or programs.  In addition, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act and the Fair Housing Act prohibits discrimination in lending practices.  The Bank’s failure to comply with the provisions of the CRA could, at a minimum, result in regulatory restrictions on its activities and the activities of the Company.  The Bank’s failure to comply with the Equal Credit Opportunity Act and the Fair Housing Act could result in enforcement actions against it by its regulators as well as other federal regulatory agencies and the Department of Justice.  The Bank’s latest CRA rating was “Satisfactory”.

The Bank Secrecy Act
The Bank Secrecy Act (“BSA”) requires all financial institutions, including banks and securities broker-dealers, to, among other things, establish a risk-based system of internal controls reasonably designed to prevent money laundering and the financing of terrorism.  The BSA includes a variety of recordkeeping and reporting requirements (such as cash and suspicious activity reporting), as well as due diligence/know-your-customer documentation requirements.  The Company has established an anti-money laundering program and taken other appropriate measures in order to comply with BSA requirements.

Item 1A. Risk Factors

There are risks inherent in the Company’s business.  The material risks and uncertainties that management believes affect the Company are described below.  Adverse experience with these could have a material impact on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

Changes in interest rates affect our profitability, assets and liabilities.

The Company’s income and cash flow depends to a great extent on the difference between the interest earned on loans and investment securities, and the interest paid on deposits and borrowings.  Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors that are beyond the Company’s control, including general economic conditions and policies of various governmental and regulatory agencies and, in particular, the FRB.  Changes in monetary policy, including changes in interest rates, could influence not only the interest we receive on loans and securities and the amount of interest we pay on deposits and borrowings, but such changes could also affect (1) our ability to originate loans and obtain deposits, which could reduce the amount of fee income generated, (2) the fair value of our financial assets and liabilities and (3) the average duration of the Company’s various categories of earning assets.  If the interest rates paid on deposits and other borrowings increase at a faster rate than the interest rates received on loans and other investments, our net interest income could be adversely affected, which in turn could negatively affect our earnings.  Earnings could also be adversely affected if the interest rates received on loans and other investments fall more quickly than the interest rates paid on deposits and other borrowings.  Although management believes it has implemented effective asset and liability management strategies to reduce the potential effects of changes in interest rates on the results of operations, any substantial, unexpected, prolonged change in market interest rates could have a material adverse effect on the financial condition and results of operations.

 
 
11

 

 
The Company operates in a highly regulated environment and may be adversely affected by changes in laws and regulations.

The Company and its subsidiaries are subject to extensive state and federal regulation, supervision and legislation that govern nearly every aspect of its operations.  The Company, as a bank holding company, is subject to regulation by the FRB and its banking subsidiary is subject to regulation by the OCC.  These regulations affect deposit and lending practices, capital levels and structure, investment practices, dividend policy and growth.  In addition, the non-bank subsidiaries are engaged in providing investment management and insurance brokerage services, which industries are also heavily regulated at both a state and federal level.  Such regulators govern the activities in which the Company and its subsidiaries may engage.  These regulatory authorities have extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory and enforcement activities, including the imposition of restrictions on the operation of a bank, the classification of assets by a bank and the adequacy of a bank’s allowance for loan losses.  Any change in such regulation and oversight, whether in the form of regulatory policy, regulations, or legislation, could have a material impact on the Company and its operations.  Changes to the regulatory laws governing these businesses could affect the Company’s ability to deliver or expand its services and adversely impact its operations and financial condition.

In July 2010, the Dodd-Frank Act was signed into law. The Dodd-Frank Act is sweeping legislation intended to overhaul regulation of the financial services industry.  Its goals are to establish a new council of “systemic risk” regulators, create a new consumer protection division, empower the Federal Reserve to supervise the largest, most complex financial companies, allow the government to seize and liquidate failing financial companies, and give regulators new powers to oversee the derivatives market. The provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act are so extensive that full implementation may require several years, and an assessment of its full effect on the Company is not possible at this time.

The Dodd-Frank Act also established the CFPB and authorizes it to supervise certain consumer financial services companies and large depository institutions and their affiliates for consumer protection purposes. Subject to the provisions of the Act, the CFPB has responsibility to implement, examine for compliance with, and enforce “Federal consumer financial law.” As a depository institution, the Company is subject to the regulations promulgated by the CFPB, which will focus on the Company’s ability to detect, prevent, and correct practices that present a significant risk of violating the law and causing consumer harm.

The CFPB’s QM Rule became effective on January 10, 2014.  The QM Rule is designed to clarify how lenders can manage the potential legal liability under the Dodd-Frank Act which would hold lenders accountable for insuring a borrower’s ability to repay a mortgage. Loans that meet this definition of “qualified mortgage” will be presumed to have complied with the new ability-to-repay standard.   The QM Rule on qualified mortgages and similar rules could limit the Bank’s ability to make certain types of loans or loans to certain borrowers, or could make it more expensive and time-consuming to make these loans, which could limit the Bank’s growth or profitability.

Compliance with new laws and regulations will likely result in additional costs and/or decreases in revenue, which could adversely impact the Company’s results of operations, financial condition or liquidity.

The provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act restricting bank interchange fees, and any rules promulgated thereunder, may negatively impact our revenues and earnings.

Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the Federal Reserve adopted a rule, effective as of October 1, 2011, addressing interchange fees for debit card transactions that is expected to lower fee income generated from this source.  This rule limits interchange fees on debit card transactions to a maximum of 21 cents per transaction plus 5 basis points of the transaction amount.  A debit card issuer may recover an additional one cent per transaction for fraud prevention purposes if the issuer complies with certain fraud-related requirements prescribed by the Federal Reserve.  Although technically the fee caps rule only applies to institutions with assets in excess of $10 billion, it is expected that smaller institutions, such as the Company, may also be impacted due to market reaction.  The Company contracts with large debit card processors and clearing networks with which it could have weaker bargaining power due to the interchange fee limitations.  As a result of the Dodd-Frank Act, the Company continues to expect to earn lower revenues on these types of transactions.

The Company may be subject to more stringent capital requirements.

As discussed above, Basel III and the Dodd-Frank Act require the federal banking agencies to establish stricter risk-based capital requirements and leverage limits for banks and bank holding companies.  Under the legislation, the federal banking agencies are required to develop capital requirements that address systemically-risky activities.  The capital rules must address, at a minimum, risks arising from significant volumes of activity in derivatives, securities products, financial guarantees, securities borrowing and lending and repurchase agreements; concentrations in assets for which reported values are based on models; and concentrations in market share for any activity that would substantially disrupt financial markets if the institutions were forced to unexpectedly cease the activity.  These requirements, and any other new regulations, could adversely affect the Company’s ability to pay dividends, or could require it to reduce business levels or to raise capital, including in ways that may adversely affect its results of operations or financial condition.
 

 
 
12

 
 
Regional economic factors may have an adverse impact on the Company’s business.

The Company’s main markets are located in the states of New York and Pennsylvania.  Most of the Company’s customers are individuals and small and medium-sized businesses which are dependent upon the regional economy.  Accordingly, the local economic conditions in these areas have a significant impact on the demand for the Company’s products and services as well as the ability of the Company’s customers to repay loans, the value of the collateral securing loans and the stability of the Company’s deposit funding sources.  A prolonged economic downturn in these markets could negatively impact the Company.

The financial services industry is highly competitive and creates competitive pressures that could adversely affect the Company’s revenue and profitability.

The financial services industry in which the Company operates is highly competitive.  The Company competes not only with commercial and other banks and thrifts, but also with insurance companies, mutual funds, hedge funds, securities brokerage firms and other companies offering financial services in the U.S., globally and over the Internet.  The Company competes on the basis of several factors, including capital, access to capital, revenue generation, products, services, transaction execution, innovation, reputation and price.  Over time, certain sectors of the financial services industry have become more concentrated, as institutions involved in a broad range of financial services have been acquired by or merged into other firms.  These developments could result in the Company’s competitors gaining greater capital and other resources, such as a broader range of products and services and geographic diversity.  The Company may experience pricing pressures as a result of these factors and as some of its competitors seek to increase market share by reducing prices or paying higher rates of interest on deposits.  Finally, technological change is influencing how individuals and firms conduct their financial affairs and changing the delivery channels for financial services, with the result that the Company may have to contend with a broader range of competitors including many that are not located within the geographic footprint of its banking office network.

The allowance for loan losses may be insufficient.

The Company’s business depends on the creditworthiness of its customers.  The Company reviews the allowance for loan losses quarterly for adequacy considering economic conditions and trends, collateral values and credit quality indicators, including past charge-off experience and levels of past due loans and nonperforming assets.  If the Company’s assumptions prove to be incorrect, the Company’s allowance for loan losses may not be sufficient to cover losses inherent in the Company’s loan portfolio, resulting in additions to the allowance.  Material additions to the allowance would materially decrease its net income.  It is possible that over time the allowance for loan losses will be inadequate to cover credit losses in the portfolio because of unanticipated adverse changes in the economy, market conditions or events adversely affecting specific customers, industries or markets.

Changes in the equity markets could materially affect the level of assets under management and the demand for other fee-based services.

Economic downturns could affect the volume of income from and demand for fee-based services.  Revenue from the wealth management and benefit plan administration businesses depends in large part on the level of assets under management and administration.  Market volatility that can lead customers to liquidate investment, as well as lower asset values, can reduce our level of assets under management and administration and thereby decrease the Company’s investment management and administration revenues.

Mortgage banking income may experience significant volatility.

Mortgage banking income is highly influenced by the level and direction of mortgage interest rates, and real estate and refinancing activity.  In lower interest rate environments, the demand for mortgage loans and refinancing activity will tend to increase.  This has the effect of increasing fee income, but could adversely impact the estimated fair value of our mortgage servicing rights as the rate of loan prepayments increase.  In higher interest rate environments, the demand for mortgage loans and refinancing activity will generally be lower.  This has the effect of decreasing fee income opportunities.

The Company depends on dividends from its banking subsidiary for cash revenues, but those dividends are subject to restrictions.

The ability of the Company to satisfy its obligations and pay cash dividends to its shareholders is primarily dependent on the earnings of and dividends from the subsidiary bank.  However, payment of dividends by the bank subsidiary is limited by dividend restrictions and capital requirements imposed by bank regulations.  The ability to pay dividends is also subject to the continued payment of interest that the Company owes on its subordinated junior debentures.  As of December 31, 2014, the Company had $102 million of subordinated junior debentures outstanding.  The Company has the right to defer payment of interest on the subordinated junior debentures for a period not exceeding 20 quarters, although the Company has not done so to date.  If the Company defers interest payments on the subordinated junior debentures, it will be prohibited, subject to certain exceptions, from paying cash dividends on the common stock until all deferred interest has been paid and interest payments on the subordinated junior debentures resumes.
 
 
 
13

 
 
The risks presented by acquisitions could adversely affect the Company’s financial condition and result of operations.

The business strategy of the Company includes growth through acquisition.  Any other future acquisitions will be accompanied by the risks commonly encountered in acquisitions.  These risks include among other things: the difficulty of integrating operations and personnel, the potential disruption of our ongoing business, the inability of the Company’s management to maximize its financial and strategic position, the inability to maintain uniform standards, controls, procedures and policies, and the impairment of relationships with employees and customers as a result of changes in ownership and management.  Further, the asset quality or other financial characteristics of a company may deteriorate after the acquisition agreement is signed or after the acquisition closes.

The Company may be required to record impairment charges related to goodwill, other intangible assets and the investment portfolio.

The Company may be required to record impairment charges in respect to goodwill, other intangible assets and the investment portfolio.  Numerous factors, including lack of liquidity for resale of certain investment securities, absence of reliable pricing information for investment securities, the economic condition of state and local municipalities, adverse changes in the business climate, adverse actions by regulators, unanticipated changes in the competitive environment or a decision to change the operations or dispose of an operating unit could have a negative effect on the investment portfolio, goodwill or other intangible assets in future periods.

The Company’s financial statements are based in part on assumptions and estimates which, if incorrect, could cause unexpected losses in the future.

Pursuant to accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, the Company is required to use certain assumptions and estimates in preparing its financial statements, including in determining credit loss reserves, mortgage repurchase liability and reserves related to litigation, among other items.  Certain of the Company’s financial instruments, including available-for-sale securities and certain loans, among other items, require a determination of their fair value in order to prepare the Company’s financial statements.  Where quoted market prices are not available, the Company may make fair value determinations based on internally developed models or other means which ultimately rely to some degree on management judgment.  Some of these and other assets and liabilities may have no direct observable price levels, making their valuation particularly subjective, as they are based on significant estimation and judgment.  In addition, sudden illiquidity in markets or declines in prices of certain loans and securities may make it more difficult to value certain balance sheet items, which may lead to the possibility that such valuations will be subject to further change or adjustment.  If assumptions or estimates underlying the Company’s financial statements are incorrect, it may experience material losses.

The Company’s information systems may experience an interruption or security breach.

The Company relies heavily on communications and information systems to conduct its business.  The Company may be the subject of sophisticated and targeted attacks intended to obtain unauthorized access to assets or confidential information, destroy data, disable or degrade service, or sabotage systems, often through the introduction of computer viruses or malware, cyber-attacks and other means.  Any failure, interruption or breach in security of these systems could result in failures or disruptions in the Company’s online banking system, its general ledger, and its deposit and loan servicing and origination systems.  Furthermore, if personal, confidential or proprietary information of customers or clients in the Company’s possession were to be mishandled or misused, the Company could suffer significant regulatory consequences, reputational damage and financial loss.  Such mishandling or misuse could include circumstances where, for example, such information was erroneously provided to parties who are not permitted to have the information, either by fault of the Company’s systems, employees, or counterparties, or where such information was intercepted or otherwise inappropriately taken by third parties.  The Company has policies and procedures designed to prevent or limit the effect of the possible failure, interruption or security breach of its information systems; however, any such failure, interruption or security breach could adversely affect the Company’s business and results of operations through loss of assets or by requiring it to expend significant resources to correct the defect, as well as exposing the Company to customer dissatisfaction and civil litigation, regulatory fines or penalties or losses not covered by insurance.

The Company may be adversely affected by the soundness of other financial institutions.

The Company owns common stock of FHLB in order to qualify for membership in the Federal Home Loan Bank system, which enables it to borrow funds under the FHLB advance program.  The carrying value of the Company’s FHLB common stock was $19.6 million as of December 31, 2014.  There are 12 branches of the Federal Home Loan Bank system, including New York.  Statutorily, to the extent that one Federal Home Loan Bank branch cannot meet its obligations to pay its share of the system’s debt, other Federal Home Loan Bank branches can be called upon to make any required payments.  Any such adverse effects on the FHLBNY could adversely affect the value of the Company’s investment in its common stock and negatively impact the Company’s results of operations.
 
 
 
14

 
 
The Company is or may become involved in lawsuits, legal proceedings, information-gathering requests, investigations, and proceedings by governmental agencies that may lead to adverse consequences.
 
As a participant in the financial services industry, many aspects of the Company’s business involve substantial risk of legal liability. The Company and its subsidiaries have been named or threatened to be named as defendants in various lawsuits arising from its or its subsidiaries’ business activities (and in some cases from the activities of acquired companies). In addition, from time to time, the Company is, or may become, the subject of governmental and self-regulatory agency information-gathering requests, reviews, investigations and proceedings and other forms of regulatory inquiry, including by bank regulatory agencies, the SEC and law enforcement authorities. The results of such proceedings could lead to significant penalties, including monetary penalties, damages, adverse judgments, settlements, fines, injunctions, restrictions on the way in which the Company conducts its business, or reputational harm.
 
Although the Company establishes accruals for legal proceedings when information related to the loss contingencies represented by those matters indicates both that a loss is probable and that the amount of loss can be reasonably estimated, the Company does not have accruals for all legal proceedings where it faces a risk of loss. In addition, due to the inherent subjectivity of the assessments and unpredictability of the outcome of legal proceedings, amounts accrued may not represent the ultimate loss to the Company from the legal proceedings in question. Thus, the Company’s ultimate losses may be higher than the amounts accrued for legal loss contingencies, which could adversely affect the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

The Company continually encounters technological change and may have to continue to invest in technological improvements.

The financial services industry is continually undergoing rapid technological change with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services.  The effective use of technology increases efficiency and enables financial institutions to better serve customers and to reduce costs.  The Company’s future success depends, in part, upon its ability to address the needs of its customers by using technology to provide products and services that will satisfy customer demands as well as to create additional efficiencies in the Company’s operations.

Trading activity in the Company’s common stock could result in material price fluctuations.

The market price of the Company’s common stock may fluctuate significantly in response to a number of other factors including, but not limited to:
  
Changes in securities analysts’ expectations of financial performance;
●  
Volatility of stock market prices and volumes;
●  
Incorrect information or speculation;
●  
Changes in industry valuations;
●  
Variations in operating results from general expectations;
●  
Actions taken against the Company by various regulatory agencies;
●  
Changes in authoritative accounting guidance by the Financial Accounting Standards Board or other regulatory agencies;
●  
Changes in general domestic economic conditions such as inflation rates, tax rates, unemployment rates, oil prices, labor and healthcare cost trend rates, recessions, and changing government policies, laws and regulations; and
●  
Severe weather, natural disasters, acts of war or terrorism and other external events

The Company’s ability to attract and retain qualified employees is critical to the success of its business, and failure to do so may have a materially adverse affect on the Company’s performance.

The Company’s employees are its most important resource, and in many areas of the financial services industry, competition for qualified personnel is intense.  The imposition on the Company or its employees of certain existing and proposed restrictions or taxes on executive compensation may adversely affect the Company’s ability to attract and retain qualified senior management and employees.  If the Company is unable to continue to retain and attract qualified employees, the Company’s performance, including its competitive position, could have a materially adverse affect.

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments
None


 
15

 


Item 2.  Properties

The Company’s primary headquarters are located at 5790 Widewaters Parkway, Dewitt, New York, which is leased.  In addition, the Company has 205 properties located in the counties identified in the table on page 5, of which 132 are owned and 73 are under lease arrangements.  With respect to the Banking segment, the Company operates 182 full-service branches and six facilities for back office banking operations.  With respect to the Employee Benefit Services segment, the Company operates nine customer service facilities, all of which are leased.  With respect to the Wealth Management segment, the Company operates eight customer service facilities, seven of which are leased and one is owned.  Some properties contain tenant leases or subleases.

Real property and related banking facilities owned by the Company at December 31, 2014 had a net book value of $58.6 million and none of the properties were subject to any material encumbrances.  For the year ended December 31, 2014, rental fees of $5.1 million were paid on facilities leased by the Company for its operations.  The Company believes that its facilities are suitable and adequate for the Company’s current operations.

Item 3.  Legal Proceedings

The Company and its subsidiaries are subject in the normal course of business to various pending and threatened legal proceedings in which claims for monetary damages are asserted. As of December 31, 2014, management, after consultation with legal counsel, does not anticipate that the aggregate ultimate liability arising out of litigation pending or threatened against the Company or its subsidiaries will be material to the Company’s consolidated financial position. On at least a quarterly basis the Company assesses its liabilities and contingencies in connection with such legal proceedings. For those matters where it is probable that the Company will incur losses and the amounts of the losses can be reasonably estimated, the Company records an expense and corresponding liability in its consolidated financial statements. To the extent the pending or threatened litigation could result in exposure in excess of that liability, the amount of such excess is not currently estimable. The range of reasonably possible losses for matters where an exposure is not currently estimatable or considered probable, beyond the existing recorded liabilities, is between $0 and $1 million in the aggregate. Although the Company does not believe that the outcome of pending litigation will be material to the Company’s consolidated financial position, it cannot rule out the possibility that such outcomes will be material to the consolidated results of operations for a particular reporting period in the future.

The Bank reached an agreement in principle to settle two related class actions pending in the United States District Court for the Middle District of Pennsylvania which were commenced October 30, 2013 and May 29, 2014, respectively.  The first action alleged that notices provided by the Bank in connection with the repossession of the named plaintiff’s automobile failed to comply with certain requirements of the Pennsylvania and New York Uniform Commercial Code (UCC) and related statutes.  The plaintiff sought to pursue the action as a class action on behalf of herself and similarly situated plaintiffs who had their automobiles repossessed and sought to recover statutory damages under the UCC. The second action filed May 29, 2014 contained similar allegations, which the plaintiff also sought to pursue as a class action for statutory damages. In both cases, the Bank contested the allegations that the notices were deficient, asserted various legal defenses and counterclaims, and opposed class certification in both of the cases.  On September 30, 2014, the Bank reached an agreement in principle to settle both actions for $2.8 million in exchange for releases of all claims.  The settlement is subject to final documentation, notice to the class members and Court approval. A litigation settlement charge of $2.8 million with respect to the settlement of the class actions was recorded in the third quarter of 2014, and is included in the Other expenses line item in the Consolidated Statements of Income.

Item 4.  Mine Safety Disclosures

Not Applicable


 
16

 


Item 4A. Executive Officers of the Registrant

The executive officers of the Company and the Bank who are elected by the Board of Directors are as follows:

Name
Age
Position
Mark E. Tryniski
 
54
Director, President and Chief Executive Officer.  Mr. Tryniski assumed his current position in August 2006. He served as Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer from March 2004 to July 2006 and as the Treasurer and Chief Financial Officer from June 2003 to March 2004. He previously served as a partner in the Syracuse office of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP.
Scott Kingsley
 
50
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer.  Mr. Kingsley joined the Company in August 2004 in his current position.  He served as Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Carlisle Engineered Products, Inc., a subsidiary of the Carlisle Companies, Inc., from 1997 until joining the Company.
Brian D. Donahue
 
58
Executive Vice President and Chief Banking Officer.  Mr. Donahue assumed his current position in August 2004.  He served as the Bank’s Chief Credit Officer from February 2000 to July 2004 and as the Senior Lending Officer for the Southern Region of the Bank from 1992 until June 2004.
George J. Getman
58
Executive Vice President and General Counsel.  Mr. Getman assumed his current position in January 2008.  Prior to joining the Company, he was a partner with Bond, Schoeneck & King, PLLC and served as corporate counsel to the Company.

Part II

Item 5.  Market for the Registrant's Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

The Company’s common stock has been trading on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “CBU” since December 31, 1997.  Prior to that, the common stock traded over-the-counter on the NASDAQ National Market under the symbol “CBSI” beginning on September 16, 1986. There were 40,792,708 shares of common stock outstanding on January 31, 2015, held by approximately 3,445 registered shareholders of record. The following table sets forth the high and low closing prices for the common stock, and the cash dividends declared with respect thereto, for the periods indicated.  The prices do not include retail mark-ups, mark-downs or commissions.

 
High
Low
Quarterly
Year / Qtr
Price
Price
Dividend
2014
     
4th
$38.99
$32.84
$0.30
3rd
$37.29
$33.59
$0.30
2nd
$39.91
$35.27
$0.28
1st
$39.43
$33.74
$0.28
       
2013
     
4th
$40.27
$33.23
$0.28
3rd
$34.71
$31.12
$0.28
2nd
$30.85
$27.64
$0.27
1st
$29.92
$27.60
$0.27
       
 
The Company has historically paid regular quarterly cash dividends on its common stock, and declared a cash dividend of $0.30 per share for the first quarter of 2015.  The Board of Directors of the Company presently intends to continue the payment of regular quarterly cash dividends on the common stock, as well as to make payment of regularly scheduled dividends on the trust preferred stock when due, subject to the Company's need for those funds.  However, because substantially all of the funds available for the payment of dividends by the Company are derived from the subsidiary Bank, future dividends will depend upon the earnings of the Bank, its financial condition, its need for funds and applicable governmental policies and regulations.
 

 
 
17

 

The following graph compares cumulative total shareholders returns on the Company’s common stock over the last five fiscal years to the S&P 600 Commercial Banks Index, the NASDAQ Bank Index, the S&P 500 Index, and the KBW Regional Banking Index. Total return values were calculated as of December 31 of each indicated year assuming a $100 investment on December 31, 2009 and reinvestment of dividends.
 


 
18

 

Equity Compensation Plan Information
The following table provides information as of December 31, 2014 with respect to shares of common stock that may be issued under the Company’s existing equity compensation plans.
 
 
Number of
 
Number of Securities
 
Securities to be
 
Remaining Available
 
Issued upon
Weighted-average
For Future Issuance
 
Exercise of
Exercise Price
Under Equity
 
Outstanding
of Outstanding
Compensation Plans
 
Options, Warrants
Options, Warrants
(excluding securities
Plan Category
and Rights (1)
and Rights
reflected in column (a))
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders:
     
  1994 Long-term Incentive Plan
85,437
$17.41
5,701
  2004 Long-term Incentive Plan
2,312,060
23.48
717,755
  2014 Long-term Incentive Plan
0
0
1,000,000
Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders
0
0
0
     Total
2,397,497
$23.27
1,723,456
 
 (1) The number of securities includes unvested restricted stock issued of 245,721.
 
Stock Repurchase Program
At its December 2013 meeting, the Board approved a stock repurchase program authorizing the repurchase, at the discretion of senior management, of up to 2,000,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, in accordance with securities laws and regulations, during a twelve-month period starting January 1, 2014. There were 123,000 treasury stock purchases in 2014.  At its December 2014 meeting, the Board approved a new stock repurchase program authorizing the repurchase, at the discretion of senior management, of up to 2,000,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, in accordance with securities laws and regulations, during  a twelve-month period starting January 1, 2015.  Any repurchased shares will be used for general corporate purposes, including those related to stock plan activities.  The timing and extent of repurchases will depend on market conditions and other corporate considerations as determined at the Company’s discretion.

The following table presents stock purchases made during the fourth quarter of 2014:

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
 
Total
 
Total Number of Shares
 
 
Number of
Average
Purchased as Part of
Maximum Number of Shares
Period
Shares
Purchased
Price Paid
Per share
Publicly Announced
Plans or Programs
That May Yet be Purchased
Under the Plans or Programs
October 1-31, 2014
123,000
$35.51
123,000
1,877,000
November 1-30, 2014
0
0
0
1,877,000
December 1-31, 2014
0
0
0
1,877,000
  Total
123,000
$35.51
   

Item 6.  Selected Financial Data

The following table sets forth selected consolidated historical financial data of the Company as of and for each of the years in the five-year period ended December 31, 2014.  The historical information set forth under the captions “Income Statement Data” and “Balance Sheet Data” is derived from the audited financial statements while the information under the captions “Capital and Related Ratios”, “Selected Performance Ratios” and “Asset Quality Ratios” for all periods is unaudited.  All financial information in this table should be read in conjunction with the information contained in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and with the Consolidated Financial Statements and the related notes thereto included elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.


 
19

 

SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL INFORMATION

 
Years Ended December 31,
(In thousands except per share data and ratios)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Income Statement Data:
         
Loan interest income
$185,527
$188,197
$192,710
$192,981
$178,703
Investment interest income
70,693
75,962
88,690
77,988
69,578
Interest expense
11,792
26,065
50,976
61,556
66,597
  Net interest income
244,428
238,094
230,424
209,413
181,684
Provision for loan losses
7,178
7,992
9,108
4,736
7,205
Noninterest income
119,020
108,748
98,955
89,283
88,792
Gain (loss) on investment securities & early retirement of long-term borrowings, net
0
(6,568)
291
(61)
0
Acquisition expenses, litigation settlement, and contract termination charges
2,923
2,181
8,247
4,831
1,365
Other noninterest expenses
223,657
219,074
203,510
185,541
175,521
Income before income taxes
129,690
111,027
108,805
103,527
86,385
     Net income
91,353
78,829
77,068
73,142
63,320
Diluted earnings per share
2.22
1.94
           1.93
2.01
1.89
           
Balance Sheet Data:
         
Cash equivalents
$12,870
$11,288
$84,415
$203,082
$114,996
Investment securities
2,512,974
2,218,725
2,818,527
2,151,370
1,742,324
Loans, net of unearned discount
4,236,206
4,109,083
3,865,576
3,471,025
3,026,363
Allowance for loan losses
(45,341)
(44,319)
(42,888)
(42,213)
(42,510)
Intangible assets
386,973
390,499
387,134
360,564
311,714
Total assets
7,489,440
7,095,864
7,496,800
6,488,275
5,444,506
Deposits
5,935,264
5,896,044
5,628,039
4,795,245
3,934,045
Borrowings
440,122
244,010
830,134
830,329
830,484
Shareholders’ equity
987,904
875,812
902,778
774,583
607,258
           
Capital and Related Ratios:
         
Cash dividends declared per share
$1.16
$1.10
$1.06
$1.00
$0.94
Book value per share
24.24
21.66
22.78
20.94
18.23
Tangible book value per share (1)
15.63
12.80
13.72
11.85
9.49
Market capitalization (in millions)
1,554
1,604
1,084
1,028
925
Tier 1 leverage ratio
9.96%
9.29%
8.40%
8.38%
8.23%
Total risk-based capital to risk-adjusted assets
18.75%
17.57%
16.20%
15.51%
14.74%
Tangible equity to tangible assets (1)
8.92%
7.68%
7.62%
7.12%
6.14%
Dividend payout ratio
51.6%
56.0%
54.3%
49.3%
49.2%
Period end common shares outstanding
40,748
40,431
39,626
36,986
33,319
Diluted weighted-average shares outstanding
41,232
40,726
39,927
36,454
33,553
           
Selected Performance Ratios:
         
Return on average assets
1.23%
1.09%
1.08%
1.18%
1.16%
Return on average equity
9.65%
9.04%
8.82%
10.36%
10.66%
Net interest margin
3.91%
3.91%
3.88%
4.07%
4.04%
Noninterest income/operating income (FTE)
31.4%
30.0%
28.6%
28.4%
31.1%
Efficiency ratio (2)
57.9%
59.3%
57.4%
57.6%
59.4%
           
Asset Quality Ratios:
         
Allowance for loan losses/total loans
1.07%
1.08%
1.11%
1.22%
1.40%
Nonperforming loans/total loans
0.56%
0.54%
0.75%
0.85%
0.61%
Allowance for loan losses/nonperforming loans
190%
201%
147%
144%
230%
Loan loss provision/net charge-offs
117%
122%
108%
94%
109%
Net charge-offs/average loans
0.15%
0.17%
0.23%
0.15%
0.21%
 
 
 (1) The tangible book value per share and the tangible equity to tangible asset ratio excludes goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, adjusted for
     deferred tax liabilities generated from tax deductible goodwill.  The ratio is not a financial measurement required by accounting principles generally
     accepted in the United States of America.  However, management believes such information is useful to analyze the relative strength of the Company’s
     capital position and is useful to investors in evaluating Company performance.
 
 
(2) Efficiency ratio provides a ratio of operating expenses to operating income.  It excludes intangible amortization, goodwill impairment, acquisition
    expenses, litigation settlement and contract termination charges from expenses and gains and losses on investment securities & early retirement of
    long-term borrowings from income while adding a fully-taxable equivalent adjustment. The efficiency ratio is not a financial measurement required by
    accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.  However, the efficiency ratio is used by management in its assessment of
    financial performance specifically as it relates to noninterest expense control.  Management also believes such information is useful to investors in
    evaluating Company performance.
 
 
 
20

 
 
Item 7.  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

This Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (“MD&A”) primarily reviews the financial condition and results of operations of the Company for the past two years, although in some circumstances a period longer than two years is covered in order to comply with SEC disclosure requirements or to more fully explain long-term trends.  The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with the Selected Consolidated Financial Information beginning on page 19 and the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements and related notes that appear on pages 50 through 90.  All references in the discussion to the financial condition and results of operations are to the consolidated position and results of the Company and its subsidiaries taken as a whole.

Unless otherwise noted, all earnings per share (“EPS”) figures disclosed in the MD&A refer to diluted EPS; interest income, net interest income and net interest margin are presented on a fully tax-equivalent (“FTE”) basis, which is a non-GAAP measure.  The term “this year” and equivalent terms refer to results in calendar year 2014, “last year” and equivalent terms refer to calendar year 2013, and all references to income statement results correspond to full-year activity unless otherwise noted.

This MD&A contains certain forward-looking statements with respect to the financial condition, results of operations and business of the Company.  These forward-looking statements involve certain risks and uncertainties.  Factors that may cause actual results to differ materially from those contemplated by such forward-looking statements are set herein under the caption “Forward-Looking Statements” on page 47.

Critical Accounting Policies

As a result of the complex and dynamic nature of the Company’s business, management must exercise judgment in selecting and applying the most appropriate accounting policies for its various areas of operations.  The policy decision process not only ensures compliance with the latest generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”), but also reflects management’s discretion with regard to choosing the most suitable methodology for reporting the Company’s financial performance.  It is management’s opinion that the accounting estimates covering certain aspects of the business have more significance than others due to the relative importance of those areas to overall performance, or the level of subjectivity in the selection process.  These estimates affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosures of revenues and expenses during the reporting period.  Actual results could differ from these estimates.  Management believes that the critical accounting estimates include:

  
Acquired loans – Acquired loans are initially recorded at their acquisition date fair values based on a discounted cash flow methodology that involves assumptions and judgments as to credit risk, prepayment risk, liquidity risk, default rates, loss severity, payment speeds, collateral values and discount rate.

Acquired loans deemed impaired at acquisition are recorded in accordance with ASC 310-30.  The excess of undiscounted cash flows expected at acquisition over the estimated fair value is referred to as the accretable discount. The difference between contractually required payments at acquisition and the undiscounted cash flows expected to be collected at acquisition is referred to as the non-accretable discount, which represents estimated future credit losses and other contractually required payments that the Company does not expect to collect. Subsequent decreases in expected cash flows are recognized as impairments through a charge to the provision for credit losses resulting in an increase in the allowance for loan losses. Subsequent improvements in expected cash flows result in a recovery of previously recorded allowance for loan losses or a reversal of a corresponding amount of the non-accretable discount, which the Company then reclassifies as an accretable discount that is recognized into interest income over the remaining life of the loans using the interest method.

For acquired loans that are not deemed impaired at acquisition, the difference between the acquisition date fair value and the outstanding balance represents the fair value adjustment for a loan and includes both credit and interest rate considerations. Subsequent to the purchase date, the methods used to estimate the allowance for loan losses for the acquired non-impaired loans is consistent with the policy described below.  However, the Company compares the net realizable value of the loans to the carrying value, for loans collectively evaluated for impairment.  The carrying value represents the net of the loan’s unpaid principal balance and the remaining purchase discount (or premium) that has yet to be accreted into interest income.  When the carrying value exceeds the net realizable value, an allowance for loan losses is recognized. For loans individually evaluated for impairment, a provision is recorded when the required allowance exceeds any remaining discount on the loan.

●  
Allowance for loan losses – The allowance for loan losses reflects management’s best estimate of probable loan losses in the Company’s loan portfolio. Determination of the allowance for loan losses is inherently subjective.  It requires significant estimates including the amounts and timing of expected future cash flows on impaired loans, appraisal values of underlying collateral for collateralized loans, and the amount of estimated losses on pools of homogeneous loans which is based on historical loss experience and consideration of current economic trends, all of which may be susceptible to significant change.


 
21

 

●  
Investment securities – Investment securities are classified as held-to-maturity, available-for-sale, or trading.  The appropriate classification is based partially on the Company’s ability to hold the securities to maturity and largely on management’s intentions with respect to either holding or selling the securities.  The classification of investment securities is significant since it directly impacts the accounting for unrealized gains and losses on securities.  Unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities are recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income or loss, as a separate component of shareholders’ equity, and do not affect earnings until realized.  The fair values of investment securities are generally determined by reference to quoted market prices, where available.  If quoted market prices are not available, fair values are based on quoted market prices of comparable instruments, or a discounted cash flow model using market estimates of interest rates and volatility.  Investment securities with significant declines in fair value are evaluated to determine whether they should be considered other-than-temporarily impaired.  An unrealized loss is generally deemed to be other-than-temporary and a credit loss is deemed to exist if the present value of the expected future cash flows is less than the amortized cost basis of the debt security.  The credit loss component of an other-than-temporary impairment write-down is recorded in earnings, while the remaining portion of the impairment loss is recognized in other comprehensive income (loss), provided the Company does not intend to sell the underlying debt security, and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the debt security prior to recovery of the full value of its amortized cost basis.  During 2013, the Company sold certain held-to-maturity securities and consequently did not use the held-to-maturity classification in 2014.

●  
Retirement benefits - The Company provides defined benefit pension benefits to eligible employees and post-retirement health and life insurance benefits to certain eligible retirees.  The Company also provides deferred compensation and supplemental executive retirement plans for selected current and former employees and officers.  Expense under these plans is charged to current operations and consists of several components of net periodic benefit cost based on various actuarial assumptions regarding future experience under the plans, including, but not limited to, discount rate, rate of future compensation increases, mortality rates, future health care costs and the expected return on plan assets.

●  
Provision for income taxes – The Company is subject to examinations from various taxing authorities.  Such examinations may result in challenges to the tax return treatment applied by the Company to specific transactions.  Management believes that the assumptions and judgments used to record tax-related assets or liabilities have been appropriate.  Should tax laws change or the taxing authorities determine that management’s assumptions were inappropriate, an adjustment may be required which could have a material effect on the Company’s results of operations.

●  
Intangible assets – As a result of acquisitions the Company carries goodwill and identifiable intangible assets.  Goodwill represents the cost of acquired companies in excess of the fair value of net assets at the acquisition date.  Goodwill is evaluated at least annually, or when business conditions suggest impairment may have occurred.  Should an impairment occur goodwill will be reduced to its carrying value through a charge to earnings.  Core deposits and other identifiable intangible assets are amortized to expense over their estimated useful lives.  The determination of whether or not impairment exists is based upon discounted cash flow modeling techniques that require management to make estimates regarding the amount and timing of expected future cash flows.  It also requires them to select a discount rate that reflects the current return requirements of the market in relation to present risk-free interest rates, required equity market premiums, and company-specific performance and risk metrics, all of which are susceptible to change based on changes in economic and market conditions and other factors.  Future events or changes in the estimates used to determine the carrying value of goodwill and identifiable intangible assets could have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations.

A summary of the accounting policies used by management is disclosed in Note A, “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies”, starting on page 56.

Executive Summary

The Company’s business philosophy is to operate as a community bank with local decision-making, principally in non-metropolitan markets, providing a broad array of banking and financial services to retail, commercial and municipal customers.

The Company’s core operating objectives are: (i) grow the branch network, primarily through a disciplined acquisition strategy, and certain selective de novo expansions, (ii) build profitable loan and deposit volume using both organic and acquisition strategies, (iii) increase the noninterest income component of total revenue through development of banking-related fee income, growth in existing financial services business units, and the acquisition of additional financial services and banking businesses, and (iv) utilize technology to deliver customer-responsive products and services and to improve efficiencies.

Significant factors management reviews to evaluate achievement of the Company’s operating objectives and its operating results and financial condition include, but are not limited to: net income and earnings per share, return on assets and equity, net interest margins, noninterest income, operating expenses, asset quality, loan and deposit growth, capital management, performance of individual banking and financial services units, performance of specific product lines, liquidity and interest rate sensitivity, enhancements to customer products and services and their underlying performance characteristics, technology advancements, market share, peer comparisons, and the performance of acquisition and integration activities.
 
 
 
22

 

 
On April 8, 2011, the Company acquired The Wilber Corporation, the parent company of Wilber National Bank (“Wilber”), for $103 million in stock and cash, comprised of $20.4 million in cash and the issuance of 3.35 million additional shares of the Company’s common stock.  Based in Oneonta, New York, Wilber operated 22 branches in the Central, Greater Capital District and Catskills regions of Upstate New York.  The acquisition added approximately $462 million of loans, $297 million of investment securities and $772 million of deposits.

On November 30, 2011, the Company, through its BPAS subsidiary, acquired certain assets and liabilities of CAI, a provider of actuarial, consulting and retirement plan administration services, with offices in New York City and Northern New Jersey.  The transaction adds valuable service capacity and enhances distribution prospects in support of the Company’s broader-based employee benefits business, including daily valuation plan and collective investment fund administration.

On July 20, 2012, the Bank completed its acquisition of 16 retail branches in central, northern and western New York from HSBC, acquiring approximately $106 million in loans and $697 million of deposits.  The assumed deposits consist primarily of core deposits (checking, savings and money market accounts) and the purchased loans consist of in-market performing loans, primarily residential real estate loans.  Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the Bank paid First Niagara (who acquired HSBC’s Upstate New York banking business and assigned its right to purchase the 16 branches to the Bank) a blended deposit premium of 3.4%, or approximately $24 million.

On September 7, 2012, the Bank completed its acquisition of three branches in central New York from First Niagara, acquiring approximately $54 million of loans and $101 million of deposits.  The assumed deposits consist primarily of core deposits (checking, savings and money market accounts) and the purchased loans consist of in-market performing loans, primarily residential real estate loans. Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the Bank paid a blended deposit premium of 3.1%, or approximately $3 million.

In support of the HSBC and First Niagara branch acquisitions, the Company completed a public common stock offering in late January 2012 and raised $57.5 million through the issuance of 2.13 million shares.  The net proceeds of the offering were approximately $54.9 million.

On December 13, 2013, the Bank completed its acquisition of eight retail branch-banking locations across its Northeast Pennsylvania markets from B of A, acquiring approximately $0.9 million in loans and $303 million of deposits.  The assumed deposits consist of $220 million of core deposits (checking, savings and money market accounts) and $83 million of time deposits.  Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the Bank paid B of A a blended deposit premium of 2.4%, or approximately $7.3 million.

On January 1, 2014, Harbridge Consulting Group, LLC completed its acquisition of a professional services practice from EBS-RMSCO, Inc., a subsidiary of The Lifetime Healthcare Companies.  This professional services practice, which provides actuarial valuation and consulting services to clients who sponsor pension and post-retirement medical and welfare plans, enhances the Company’s participation in the Western New York marketplace and added $1.2 million of incremental revenue in 2014.

The Company reported net income for the year ended December 31, 2014 of $91.4 million, 15.9% above 2013’s reported net income of $78.8 million.  Earnings per share of $2.22 for full year 2014 were $0.28 above the prior year level.  The increase in net income was due to an increase in net interest income, higher noninterest income, the absence of net loss on the sale of investment securities and debt extinguishments, a lower provision for loan losses, and lower acquisition expenses.  Offsetting these positive items were increased operating expenses and a $2.8 million, or $0.05 per share, litigation settlement charge.  The 2013 results included $2.2 million, or $0.04 per share, of acquisition expenses related to the B of A branch acquisition and a $6.6 million, or $0.12 per share, net loss on the sale of investment securities and debt extinguishments.  The litigation settlement charge in 2014 pertains to the settlement of a class action lawsuit involving the sufficiency of consumer notice requirements for certain of the Company’s collateral recovery activities.  The loss in 2013 on the sale of investment securities and debt extinguishments resulted from the sale of the Company’s portfolio of bank and insurance company trust preferred collateralized debt obligation (CDO) securities in response to the uncertainties created by the initial announcement of the final rules implementing Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act, commonly known as the “Volcker Rule.”
 
The Company experienced year-over-year growth in average interest-earning assets, reflective of strong organic loan growth and the impact of the B of A branch acquisition completed in the fourth quarter of 2013, partially offset by the continued effects of the balance sheet restructuring that occurred during the first half of 2013, whereby certain longer duration investment securities were sold and a portion of the Company’s existing FHLB borrowings were retired, as well as the sale of certain investments at the end of 2013 in response to “Volcker Rule”, as mentioned in the previous paragraph.  Average deposits increased in 2014 as compared to 2013, reflective of a full year of the deposits acquired in December 2013 as well as organic growth in core deposits, offset by a reduction in time deposit balances.  Average external borrowings in 2014 decreased from 2013 reflective of the Company’s balance sheet restructuring activities undertaken during 2013 and the funding provided by the acquisition.
 
 
 
23

 

 
Asset quality in 2014 remained stable and favorable in comparison to averages for peer financial organizations.  As compared to 2013, net loan charge-off ratios and loan delinquency ratios were modestly improved.  Year-end 2014 nonperforming loan ratios were slightly higher than the 2013 levels but remain favorable.
 
On February 24, 2015, the Company announced that it had entered into a definitive agreement to acquire Oneida Financial Corp. (“Oneida”), parent company of Oneida Savings Bank headquartered in Oneida, NY for approximately $142 million in Company stock and cash.  The acquisition will extend the Company’s Central New York banking service area and complement the Company’s existing non-banking service capacity in the insurance, benefits administration and wealth management businesses.  Upon the completion of the merger, Community Bank will add 12 branch locations and approximately $800 million of assets, including loans of $370 million and $690 million of deposits.  The acquisition is expected to close during the third quarter of 2015, pending both customary regulatory and Oneida shareholder approval.  The Company expects to incur certain one-time, transaction-related costs in 2015.
 
Net Income and Profitability

Net income for 2014 was $91.4 million, an increase of $12.5 million, or 15.9%, from 2013’s earnings, while earnings per share for 2014 were $2.22, up $0.28 from 2013’s results.  The 2014 results included a $2.8 million ($0.05 per share) litigation settlement charge.  The 2013 results included $6.6 million, or $0.12 per share, net loss on the sale of certain investment securities and debt extinguishments, as well as $2.2 million, or $0.04 per share, of acquisition expenses related to the B of A branch acquisition in December 2013.
 
Net income for 2013 was $78.8 million, an increase of $1.8 million, or 2.3%, from 2012’s earnings of $77.1 million.  Earnings per share for 2013 were $1.94, up $0.01 from 2012’s earnings per share of $1.93.  The 2013 results included the aforementioned $6.6 million, or $0.12 per share, net loss on the sale of certain investment securities and debt extinguishments and $2.2 million, or $0.04 per share, of acquisition expenses.  The 2012 results included $5.7 million, or $0.10 per share, of acquisition expenses principally related to the Company’s acquisition of the HSBC and First Niagara branch acquisitions, as well as a $2.5 million, or $0.05 per share, litigation settlement charge.

Table 1: Condensed Income Statements

 
Years Ended December 31,
(000’s omitted, except per share data)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Net interest income
$244,428
$238,094
$230,424
$209,413
$181,684
Provision for loan losses
7,178
7,992
9,108
4,736
7,205
Gain on sales of investment securities, net
0
80,768
291
30
0
Loss on debt extinguishments
0
87,336
0
91
0
Noninterest income
119,020
108,748
98,955
89,283
88,792
Acquisition expenses, litigation settlement, and contract termination charges
2,923
2,181
8,247
4,831
1,365
Other noninterest expenses
223,657
219,074
203,510
185,541
175,521
Income before taxes
129,690
111,027
108,805
103,527
86,385
Income taxes
38,337
32,198
31,737
30,385
23,065
Net income
$91,353
$78,829
$77,068
$73,142
$63,320
           
Diluted weighted average common shares outstanding
41,232
40,726
39,927
36,454
33,553
Diluted earnings per share
$2.22
$1.94
$1.93
$2.01
$1.89

The Company operates in three business segments: banking, employee benefit services and wealth management services.  The banking segment provides a wide array of lending and depository-related products and services to individuals, businesses, and municipal enterprises.  In addition to general liquidity and intermediation services, the Banking segment provides treasury management solutions, capital financing products, and payment processing services.  Employee benefit services, consisting of BPAS, Harbridge, and HB&T, provides employee benefit trust, collective investment fund, retirement plan administration, actuarial, VEBA/HRA and health and welfare consulting services on a national basis.  It provides services to 3,600 plan sponsors and 372,000 participants, holds $18 billion in assets under custody or administration, employs 235 professionals and operates out of nine offices located in New York, New Jersey, Pennsylvania, Texas and Puerto Rico.   Wealth management services activities include trust services provided by the personal trust unit of CBNA, investment and insurance products and services provided by CISI and CBNA Insurance, and asset advisory services provided by Nottingham.  For additional financial information on the Company’s segments, refer to Note T: Segment Information in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
 
24

 
 
The primary factors explaining 2014 earnings performance are discussed in the remaining sections of this document and are summarized as follows:

Banking
●  
As shown in Table 1 above, net interest income increased $6.3 million, or 2.7%.  This was the result of a $173.0 million increase in average earning assets while the net interest margin remained consistent with the prior year.  Average loans grew $202.3 million due to solid organic growth in the consumer mortgage, consumer indirect, and consumer direct lending portfolios.  Partially offsetting the loan growth was a $29.3 million, or 1.2%, decrease in the average book value of investments, including cash equivalents, due to the balance sheet restructuring in the first half of 2013 and the sale certain investments in late December 2013.  Average deposits increased $287.9 million, or 5.1%, due to the branch acquisition and organic core deposit growth.  Average borrowings decreased $161.7 million, or 28.5%, as compared to the prior year, primarily due to the balance sheet restructuring and FHLB term advance extinguishments occurring in 2013.
 
●  
The loan loss provision of $7.2 million decreased $0.8 million, or 10.2%, from the prior year level.  Net charge-offs of $6.2 million were $0.4 million, or 6.2%, lower than 2013.  This helped to lower the net charge-off ratio (net charge-offs / total average loans) two basis points to 0.15% for the year.  Nonperforming loans as a percentage of total loans and nonperforming assets as a percentage of loans and other real estate owned, increased two basis points and decreased five basis points, respectively, as compared to December 31, 2013 levels and remain well below averages for the Company’s peers.  Additional information on trends and policy related to asset quality is provided in the asset quality section on pages 38 through 42.

●  
Excluding net gain on sales of investment securities and loss on debt extinguishments, banking noninterest income for 2014 of $58.6 million increased by $4.0 million, or 7.3%, from 2013’s level primarily due to the branch acquisitions and organic growth across the franchise.  Fees from banking services were $4.2 million, or 7.9%, higher primarily due to higher debit card-related revenue and a full year of deposit relationships acquired in the B of A branch acquisition.  Additionally, 2014 mortgage banking revenue decreased $0.2 million as 2013 included the recovery of $0.4 million of previously recorded valuation allowances related to mortgage servicing rights.
 
●  
Total banking noninterest expenses, including acquisition expenses, litigation settlement, and contract termination charges increased $3.2 million, or 1.8%, in 2014 to $181.9 million, reflective of acquired and organic growth initiatives and investments in technology infrastructure over the past two years.  Excluding acquisition expenses, litigation settlement, and contract termination charges, banking noninterest expenses increased $2.5 million, or 1.4%, due in most part to the branch acquisitions in late 2013.

Employee Benefit Services
●  
Employee benefit services noninterest income for 2014 of $43.7 million was an increase of $4.2 million, or 10.5%, from the prior year level, benefiting from new and expanded customer relationships, along with increased asset-based fee income augmented by favorable financial market conditions.

●  
Employee benefit services noninterest expenses for 2014 totaled $33.5 million.  This amounted to an increase from 2013 of $1.8 million, or 5.6%, and was attributable to the support of a higher revenue base including the successful integration of the EBS-RMSCO business acquired January1, 2014.

Wealth Management Services
●  
Wealth management services noninterest income for 2014 was $18.6 million, an increase of $2.4 million, or 14.6%, from the prior year level.  The increase was due to positive market conditions, as well as additional resources and customers generated by both organic and acquired growth sources.

●  
Wealth management services noninterest expenses of $13.1 million increased $0.6 million, or 4.6%, from 2013 primarily due to increased compensation associated with the revenue growth.

Selected Profitability and Other Measures

Return on average assets, return on average equity, dividend payout and equity to asset ratios for the years indicated are as follows:
 
Table 2: Selected Ratios

 
2014
2013
2012
Return on average assets
1.23%
1.09%
1.08%
Return on average equity
9.65%
9.04%
8.82%
Dividend payout ratio
51.6%
56.0%
54.3%
Average equity to average assets
12.75%
12.11%
12.22%
 
 
25

 

 
As displayed in Table 2 above, both the return on average assets and the return on average equity ratios increased in 2014 as compared to 2013.  The increase in return on average assets was the result of a significant increase in net income accomplished without a significant additional investment in assets.  The increase in return on average equity was the result of the increase in net income outpacing the increase in average shareholders’ equity.  The return on average assets and the return on average equity increased in 2013 as compared to 2012.  The increase in return on average assets was the result of net income increasing at a faster pace than average assets due in large part to noninterest income growth and a lower provision for loan losses.  The 2013 increase in return on average equity was due to increased net income while average equity declined primarily due to the balance sheet restructure in the first half of the year and market-related changes in the unrealized gains and losses on the available-for-sale portfolio during the year.

The dividend payout ratio for 2014 decreased 4.4 percentage points from 2013 as net income increased at a 15.9% rate from 2013 while dividends declared increased at a slower 6.8%, as a result of a 5.5% increase in the dividends declared per share as well as an increase in the shares outstanding due to the shares issued in conjunction with the employee stock plan during 2014 and 2013.  The dividend payout ratio for 2013 was an increase of 1.7 percentage points from 2012 as dividends declared increased 5.4%, primarily as a result of a 3.8% increase in the dividends declared per share as well as the additional 0.8 million shares issued in conjunction with the employee stock plan, while net income increased at a smaller 2.2% rate from 2012.
 
Net Interest Income

Net interest income is the amount that interest and fees on earning assets (loans, investments and interest-bearing cash) exceeds the cost of funds, which consists primarily of interest paid to the Company's depositors and interest on external borrowings.  Net interest margin is the difference between the gross yield on earning assets and the cost of interest-bearing funds as a percentage of earning assets.

As disclosed in Table 3, net interest income (with nontaxable income converted to a fully tax-equivalent basis) totaled $260.0 million in 2014, up $6.8 million, or 2.7%, from the prior year.  This is a result of a $173.0 million, or 2.7%, increase in average interest-earning assets, a 28 basis point decrease in the average rate on interest-bearing liabilities and a $3.6 million decrease in average interest-bearing liabilities, partially offset by a 23 basis point decline in the average yield on interest-earning assets.  As reflected in Table 4, the favorable impacts of the lower rate on interest-bearing liabilities ($14.3 million), the increase in interest-earning assets ($7.3 million) and the decrease in interest-bearing liabilities ($0.02 million) were partially offset by a $14.8 million unfavorable impact from the decrease in the yield on interest-bearing assets.

The 2014 net interest margin was consistent with the 3.91% in 2013.  This result was attributable to a 28 basis point decrease in the cost of interest-bearing liabilities being offset by the 23 basis point decrease in earning-asset yield.  The yield on loans decreased 29 basis points in 2014 to 4.49% from 4.78% in 2013, due to new loan volume carrying lower yields in the current low-rate environment than the loans maturing or being prepaid, as well as certain adjustable rate loans re-pricing downward.  The yield on investments, including cash equivalents, decreased from 3.58% in 2013 to 3.42% in 2014.  This is reflective of the balance sheet restructuring program completed in the first half of 2013 and the sale of the Company’s collateralized debt obligation (“CDO”) portfolio and certain Treasury securities at the end of 2013 and the purchase of lower-yielding Treasury securities at various times throughout the last 24 months.  The cost of interest-bearing liabilities decreased to 0.23% during 2014 as compared to 0.51% for 2013.  The decreased rate reflects the extinguishment of the higher rate FHLB borrowings in 2013 resulting in the use of lower rate overnight borrowings to cover current liquidity needs, as well as continued disciplined deposit pricing, whereby interest rates on essentially all deposit account categories were lowered throughout 2013 and 2014 in response to market conditions.  Additionally, the proportion of customer deposits in higher cost time deposits declined 2.4 percentage points in 2014, while the percentage of deposits in non-interest bearing and lower cost checking accounts correspondingly increased.
 
The net interest margin in 2013 was 3.91%, compared to 3.88% in 2012.  This three basis point increase was attributable to a 47 basis point decrease in the cost of interest-bearing liabilities having a greater impact than a 36 basis point decrease in earning-asset yields.  The yield on loans decreased 56 basis points in 2013 to 4.78% from 5.34% in 2012, due to new loan volume carrying lower yields in the current low-rate environment than the loans maturing or being prepaid, as well as certain adjustable rate loans re-pricing downward.  The yield on investments, including cash equivalents, decreased from 3.80% in 2012 to 3.58% in 2013.  During the first six months of 2013, the Company sold $648.7 million of U.S. Treasury and agency securities, with an average yield of 2.78%, realizing $63.8 million of gains. The proceeds were utilized to retire $501.6 million of FHLB borrowings with an average cost of 4.15% that had $63.5 million of associated early extinguishments costs.  These actions enhanced the Company’s regulatory capital position, while positively impacting expected future net interest income generation.  During the first nine months of the year, the Company purchased $650 million of U.S. Treasury securities with an average yield of 2.49% in anticipation of the excess funding expected from the pending branch acquisition and certain other expected contractual cash flows.  The cost of funding, including the impact of non-interest checking deposits, decreased 41 basis points during 2013 to 0.42% as compared to 0.83% for 2012.  The decreased cost of funds was reflective of the extinguishment of the higher rate FHLB borrowings previously discussed, as well as continued disciplined deposit pricing, whereby interest rates on essentially all deposit account categories were lowered throughout 2013 and 2012 in response to market conditions.  Additionally, the proportion of customer deposits in higher cost time deposits declined 2.9 percentage points in 2013, while the percentage of deposits in non-interest bearing and lower cost checking accounts correspondingly increased.


 
26

 


As shown in Table 3, total FTE-basis interest income decreased by $7.5 million, or 2.7% in 2014 in comparison to 2013. Table 4 indicates that a lower average yield on earning assets had a negative impact of $14.8 million.  This was mostly offset by a higher average earning-asset balance that created $7.3 million of incremental interest income.  Average loans increased a total of $202.3 million in 2014, a result of organic growth in the consumer indirect, business lending, consumer direct, and consumer mortgage portfolios, partially offset by a small decline in the home equity loan portfolio.  FTE-basis loan interest income and fees decreased $2.4 million, or 1.3%, in 2014 as compared to 2013, attributable to the 29 basis point decrease in loan yields, partially offset by higher average balances.  On an FTE basis, 2014 investment interest income, including interest earned on average cash equivalents, of $85.0 million was $5.0 million, or 5.6%, lower than the prior year as a result of a 16 basis point decrease in the yield as well as a decline in the size of the portfolio.  For 2014 average investments, including cash equivalents, were $29.3 million lower than 2013, reflective of the balance sheet restructuring program completed in the first half of 2013 and the sale of the Company’s collateralized debt obligation (“CDO”) portfolio and certain Treasury securities at the end of 2013, partially offset by the purchase of Treasury securities at various times throughout the last 24 months.

Total interest income decreased by $19.1 million, or 6.4%, in 2013 from 2012’s level.  Table 4 indicates that higher average earning assets created $4.4 million of incremental interest income, offset by lower yields with a negative impact of $23.5 million.  Average loans increased a total of $326.5 million in 2013, primarily as result of strong organic growth in the consumer mortgage and consumer indirect portfolios, as well as the full year impact of the loans added in the HSBC and First Niagara branch acquisitions in the third quarter of 2012.  Loan interest income and fees decreased $4.7 million or 2.4% in 2013 as compared to 2012, attributable to the 56-basis point decrease in loan yields, partially offset by higher average loan balances.  On an FTE basis, investment interest income, including interest on average cash equivalents, of $90.0 million in 2013, was $14.4 million, or 13.8%, lower than the prior year as a result of a smaller portfolio and a 22-basis point decrease in the investment yield.  Average investments for 2013, including cash equivalents, were $231.6 million lower than 2012, reflective of the balance sheet restructure in the first half of 2013, partially offset by the purchase of U.S. Treasury securities in anticipation of the excess funding expected from the branch acquisition completed in the fourth quarter of 2013.

Total average funding (deposits and borrowings) in 2014 increased $126.2 million, or 2.0%.  Average deposits increased $287.9 million, of which approximately $240.9 million was attributable to the B of A acquisition with the remaining $47.0 million attributable to organic deposit growth.  Consistent with the Company’s funding mix objective and customers unwillingness to commit to less liquid instruments in the low rate environment, average core deposit balances increased $383.0 million, while time deposits declined $95.1 million year-over-year.  Average external borrowings decreased $161.7 million in 2014 as compared to the prior year, reflective of a full year of the effects of the restructuring program undertaken during the first half of 2013, as well as borrowings being replaced by the liquidity provided by the branch acquisition in December 2013.  In 2013, total average funding increased $72.8 million or 1.2%.  Average deposits increased $453.2 million, of which approximately $359.3 million was attributable to the HSBC and First Niagara branch acquisitions, $14.8 million was attributable to the B of A acquisition and the remaining $79.1 million was attributable to organic deposit growth.  Average core deposit balances increased $575.4 million, while time deposits declined $122.2 million year-over-year.  Average external borrowings decreased $380.4 million in 2013 as compared to the prior year, reflective of the restructuring program in the first half of 2013 which retired $501.6 million of FHLB borrowings, partially offset by the initiative in the second and third quarter of 2013 to use short-term borrowings to pre-invest a portion of the liquidity expected from the branch acquisition in the fourth quarter of 2013.

Total interest expense decreased by $14.3 million, or 55%, to $11.8 million in 2014.  As shown in Table 4, lower interest rates on interest-bearing liabilities resulted in nearly all of this decrease, while lower external borrowing balances were offset by higher deposit balances.  Interest expense as a percentage of average earning assets decreased 22 basis points to 0.18%.  The rate on interest-bearing deposits decreased seven basis points to 0.17% due to the reduction of rates in all interest-bearing categories throughout 2013 and 2014 and the change in deposit mix with a lower proportion of time deposits products.  The rate on external borrowings decreased 181 basis points to 0.89% in 2014 primarily due to the balance sheet restructuring in the first half of 2013 that retired $501.6 million of higher rate FHLB borrowings and by the initiative in the second and third quarter of 2013 to use lower rate short-term borrowings to pre-invest a portion of the liquidity expected from the branch acquisition in the fourth quarter of 2013, as well as additional liquidity needs in 2014.  Total interest expense decreased by $24.9 million to $26.1 million in 2013 as compared to 2012.  Lower interest rates on deposits and external borrowings resulted in $24.4 million of this decrease, while lower external borrowing balances, partially offset by higher deposit balances accounted for a decrease of $0.6 million in interest expense.  Interest expense as a percentage of earning assets decreased by 40 basis points to 0.40%.  The rate on interest-bearing deposits decreased 19 basis points to 0.24% due to the reduction of rates in all interest-bearing categories throughout 2012 and 2013 and the previously discussed decline of higher rate time deposit balances.  The rate on external borrowings decreased 76 basis points to 2.70% in 2013 primarily due to the balance sheet restructuring in the first half of 2013 which retired $501.6 million of FHLB borrowings and by the initiative in the second and third quarter of 2013 to use short-term borrowings to pre-invest a portion of the liquidity expected from the branch acquisition in the fourth quarter of 2013.


 
27

 


The following table sets forth information related to average interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities and their associated yields and rates for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.  Interest income and yields are on a fully tax-equivalent basis using marginal income tax rates of 38.7% in 2014 and 39.1% in 2013 and 38.8% in 2012.  Average balances are computed by totaling the daily ending balances in a period and dividing by the number of days in that period.  Loan yields and amounts earned include loan fees.  Average loan balances include nonaccrual loans and loans held for sale.

Table 3: Average Balance Sheet
 
Year Ended December 31, 2014
 
Year Ended December 31, 2013
 
Year Ended December 31, 2012
     
Avg.
     
Avg.
     
Avg.
 
Average
 
Yield/Rate
 
Average
 
Yield/Rate
 
Average
 
Yield/Rate
(000's omitted except yields and rates) 
Balance
Interest
Paid
 
Balance
Interest
Paid
 
Balance
Interest
Paid
                       
Interest-earning assets:
                     
   Cash equivalents
$9,701
$21
0.21%
 
$62,584
$159
0.25%
 
$126,714 
$330
0.26%
   Taxable investment securities (1)
1,834,430
52,268
2.85%
 
1,806,137
56,646
3.14%
 
1,939,998 
66,857
3.45%
   Nontaxable investment securities (1)
640,737
32,737
5.11%
 
645,464
33,242
5.15%
 
679,119 
37,278
5.49%
   Loans (net of unearned discount)(2)
4,156,840
186,727
4.49%
 
3,954,515
189,172
4.78%
 
3,628,006 
193,841
5.34%
       Total interest-earning assets
6,641,708
271,753
4.09%
 
6,468,700
279,219
4.32%
 
6,373,837 
298,306
4.68%
Noninterest-earning assets
782,195
     
732,347
     
780,497 
   
     Total assets
$7,423,903
     
$7,201,047
     
$7,154,334 
   
                       
Interest-bearing liabilities:
                     
   Interest checking, savings and money market deposits
$3,867,818
3,614
0.09%
 
$3,614,722 
3,773
0.10%
 
$3,169,651
6,895
0.22%
   Time deposits
845,035
4,576
0.54%
 
940,095 
6,959
0.74%
 
1,062,307
11,267
1.06%
   Borrowings
405,411
3,602
0.89%
 
567,079 
15,333
2.70%
 
947,454
32,814
3.46%
     Total interest-bearing liabilities
5,118,264
11,792
0.23%
 
5,121,896 
26,065
0.51%
 
5,179,412
50,976
0.98%
Noninterest-bearing liabilities:
                     
   Noninterest checking deposits
1,249,807
     
1,119,935
     
989,631
   
   Other liabilities
109,206
     
86,920
     
111,051
   
Shareholders' equity
946,626
     
872,296
     
874,240 
   
     Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
$7,423,903
     
$7,201,047
     
$7,154,334 
   
                       
Net interest earnings
 
$259,961
     
$253,154
     
$247,330
 
                       
Net interest spread
   
3.86%
     
3.81%
     
3.70%
Net interest margin on interest-earning assets
   
3.91%
     
3.91%
     
3.88%
                       
Fully tax-equivalent adjustment
 
$15,533
     
$15,060
     
$16,906
 
 
 (1) Averages for investment securities are based on historical cost and the yields do not give effect to changes in fair value that is reflected as a component of shareholders’
      equity and deferred taxes.
 (2)  Includes nonaccrual loans.  The impact of interest and fees not recognized on nonaccrual loans was immaterial.
 
 

 
28

 


As discussed above, the change in net interest income (fully tax-equivalent basis) may be analyzed by segregating the volume and rate components of the changes in interest income and interest expense for each underlying category.

Table 4: Rate/Volume
 
2014 Compared to 2013
 
2013 Compared to 2012
 
Increase (Decrease) Due to Change in (1)
 
Increase (Decrease) Due to Change in (1)
     
Net
     
Net
(000's omitted)
Volume
Rate
Change
 
Volume
Rate
Change
Interest earned on:
             
  Cash equivalents
($115)
($23)
($138)
 
($164)
($7)
($171)
  Taxable investment securities
875
(5,253)
(4,378)
 
(4,433)
(5,778)
(10,211)
  Nontaxable investment securities
(243)
(262)
(505)
 
(1,796)
(2,240)
(4,036)
  Loans (net of unearned discount)
9,410
(11,855)
(2,445)
 
16,600
(21,269)
(4,669)
Total interest-earning assets (2)
7,336
(14,802)
(7,466)
 
4,385
(23,472)
(19,087)
               
Interest paid on:
             
  Interest checking, savings and money market deposits
253
(412)
(159)
 
861
(3,983)
(3,122)
  Time deposits
(652)
(1,731)
(2,383)
 
(1,188)
(3,120)
(4,308)
  Borrowings
(3,496)
(8,235)
(11,731)
 
(11,306)
(6,175)
(17,481)
Total interest-bearing liabilities (2)
(18)
(14,255)
(14,273)
 
(560)
(24,351)
(24,911)
               
Net interest earnings (2)
$6,772
$35
$6,807
 
$3,701
$2,123
$5,824

 
(1) The change in interest due to both rate and volume has been allocated to volume and rate changes in proportion to the relationship of the absolute dollar
     amounts of change in each.
 
(2) Changes due to volume and rate are computed from the respective changes in average balances and rates of the totals; they are not a summation of the
     changes of the components.

Noninterest Income

The Company’s sources of noninterest income are of three primary types: 1) general banking services related to loans, deposits and other core customer activities typically provided through the branch network and electronic banking channels (performed by CBNA); 2) employee benefit services (performed by BPAS); and 3) wealth management services, comprised of trust services (performed by the personal trust unit within CBNA), investment and insurance products and services (performed by CISI and CBNA Insurance), and investment advisory services (performed by Nottingham).  Additionally, the Company has periodic transactions, most often net gains (losses) from the sale of investment securities and prepayment of debt instruments.

Table 5: Noninterest Income

 
Years Ended December 31,
(000's omitted except ratios)
2014
2013
2012
Employee benefit services
$42,580 
$38,596
$35,946
Deposit service charges and fees
29,379 
28,595
26,840
Electronic banking
21,156 
18,480
17,025
Wealth management services
17,870 
15,550
12,876
Other banking revenues
6,576 
5,854
5,425
Mortgage banking
1,459 
1,673
843
     Subtotal
119,020 
108,748
98,955
Gain on sales of investment securities, net
80,768
291
Loss on debt extinguishments
(87,336)
0
      Total noninterest income
$119,020 
$102,180
$99,246
       
Noninterest income/operating income (FTE basis) (1)
31.4% 
30.0%
28.6%

 
(1) For purposes of this ratio noninterest income excludes gain on sales of investment
     securities and loss on debt extinguishments. Operating income is defined as net
     interest income on a fully-tax equivalent basis, plus noninterest income, excluding
     gain on sales of investment securities and loss on debt extinguishments.
 
 
 
29

 

 
As displayed in Table 5, noninterest income, excluding security gains and losses and debt extinguishments costs, of $119.0 million for 2014 increased $10.3 million, or 9.4%.  The increase was a result of growth in revenue from the Company’s financial services businesses, increased debit card-related income, and higher banking fees due to the B of A branch acquisition.  Total noninterest income, excluding security gains and losses and debt extinguishments costs, increased by $9.8 million to $108.7 million in 2013 as compared to 2012, comprised of growth in revenue from the Company’s financial services businesses,  increased debit card related income, higher banking fees due to the HSBC and First Niagara branch acquisitions and higher mortgage banking income.
 
Noninterest income as a percent of operating income (FTE basis) was 31.4% in 2014, up 1.4 percentage points from the prior year.  The current year increase was due to the 9.4% increase in noninterest income mentioned above, while net interest income (FTE basis) increased at a lower rate of 2.7%.  The increase from 2012 to 2013 of 1.4 percentage points was driven by a 9.9% increase in noninterest income, primarily the result of solid organic growth in the financial services businesses, the HSBC and First Niagara branch acquisitions and strong growth in debit card related income while net interest income increased at a smaller rate of 4.5%.

The largest portion of the Company’s recurring noninterest income is the wide variety of fees earned from general banking services, which amounted to $57.1 million in 2014, up $4.2 million, or 7.9%, from the prior year.  The increase was driven by the addition of new deposit relationships from both acquired and organic sources, as well as solid growth in debit card-related revenue and the annual dividend from retail insurance programs that more than offset the continuing trend of lower utilization of overdraft protection programs and other deposit-related services.  Electronic banking revenue grew $2.7 million due in large part to a continued concerted effort to increase the penetration and utilization of consumer debit and credit cards.  Fees from general banking services were $52.9 million in 2013, up $3.6 million, or 7.4%, from 2012.  The increase was due to the addition of new deposit relationships from both acquired and organic growth, as well as solid growth in debit card-related revenue.   

In 2014, mortgage banking revenue decreased $0.2 million from the revenue generated in 2013, which was up $0.8 million from 2012, reflective of the decision to hold a majority of secondary market eligible mortgages in portfolio from mid-2011 through the first quarter of 2013.  Beginning in the second quarter of 2013, the Company began selling conforming 30 year mortgages in the secondary market.  Residential mortgage banking income consists of realized gains or losses from the sale of residential mortgage loans and the origination of mortgage loan servicing rights, unrealized gains and losses on residential mortgage loans held for sale and related commitments, mortgage loan servicing fees and other mortgage loan-related fee income.  Included in 2013’s mortgage banking revenue is a net impairment recovery of $0.4 million for the fair value of the mortgage servicing rights due primarily to a decrease in the expected prepayment speed of the Company’s sold loan portfolio with servicing retained.  Residential mortgage loans sold to investors, primarily Fannie Mae, in 2014 totaled $25.7 million as compared to $25.2 million and $3.6 million during 2013 and 2012, respectively.  Residential mortgage loans held for sale and recorded at fair value at December 31, 2014 and 2013 totaled $1.0 million and $0.7 million, respectively.  Realization of the unrealized gains or losses on mortgage loans held for sale and the related commitments, as well as future revenue generation from mortgage banking activities, will be dependent on market conditions and long-term interest rate trends.

As disclosed in Table 5, noninterest income from financial services (revenues from employee benefit services and wealth management services) increased $6.3 million, or 11.6%, in 2014 to $60.5 million.  In 2014 financial services revenue accounted for 51% of total noninterest income, excluding net gains (losses) on the sale of investment securities and debt extinguishments.  Employee benefit services generated revenue growth of $4.0 million, or 10.3%, in 2014 driven by a combination of new client generation, expanded service offerings, the EBS-RMSCO acquisition and an increase in asset-based revenue.  Employee benefit services revenue of $38.6 million in 2013 was $2.7 million higher than 2012’s results, primarily driven by a combination of new client generation, expanded service offerings and increased asset-based revenue.

Wealth management services revenue increased $2.3 million, or 14.9%, in 2014.  Personal trust revenue increased $0.4 million, CISI revenue increased $1.6 million, Nottingham revenue increased $0.3 million, and CBNA Insurance revenue increased a nominal amount. The improved revenue generation of the wealth management services was driven by solid organic growth in trust, investment product sales and asset advisory services, as well as favorable market conditions.  Wealth management services revenue in 2013 increased $2.7 million, or 21%, as compared to 2012.  Personal trust revenue increased $0.3 million, CISI revenue increased $2.0 million, Nottingham revenue increased $0.3 million and CBNA Insurance revenue increased $0.1 million. The improved revenue generation of the wealth management services was reflective of positive market conditions and additional resources and customers from both organic and acquired growth initiatives.


 
30

 


Assets under administration within the Company’s employee benefit services segment increased $2.1 billion to $18.2 billion at the end of 2014 from $16.1 billion at year-end 2013, primarily as a result of additions to the collective investment fund administration business and higher equity market valuations.  Assets under management with the Company’s wealth management services segment increased $0.2 billion to $3.6 billion at the end of 2014 from $3.4 billion at year-end 2013 due to market-driven gains in equity-based assets and the addition of new client assets.  Assets under administration increased $10.8 billion for the employee benefit services segment in 2013 as compared to 2012 as a result of additions to the collective investment fund administration business and higher equity market valuations.  Assets under management increased $0.5 billion for the wealth management businesses at year end 2013 as compared to one year earlier due to market-driven gains in equity-based assets and the addition of new client assets.

In the first half of 2013, the company sold $648.7 million of investment securities, realizing $63.8 million of gains, and utilized the proceeds to retire FHLB borrowings of $501.6 million with $63.5 million of early extinguishment costs.  In late December 2013, in response to the uncertainties created by the announcement of the final regulations implementing the Volcker Rule, the Company sold its entire portfolio of bank and insurance trust preferred collateralized debt obligation securities (CDOs), recognizing a $15.4 million loss on the sale.  In conjunction with the liquidation of the trust preferred CDOs, the Company also extinguished $226 million of FHLB advances with $23.8 million of early extinguishment costs and sold $418 million of U.S. Treasury securities previously classified as held-to-maturity, realizing $32.4 million of gains.  There were no sales of investments or debt extinguishments in 2014.

Noninterest Expenses

As shown in Table 6, noninterest expenses increased $5.3 million, or 2.4%, in 2014 to $226.6 million and include a litigation settlement charge of $2.8 million and non-recurring acquisition expenses of $0.1 million, as well as incremental operating expenses from the B of A branch acquisition.  Noninterest expenses of $221.3 million in 2013 were $9.5 million, or 4.5%, higher than 2012 and include non-recurring acquisition expenses as well as incremental operating expenses from the HSBC, First Niagara and B of A acquisitions.  Operating expenses (excluding acquisitions expenses, litigation settlement charge and amortization of intangible assets) as a percent of average assets for 2014 was 2.95%, down three basis points from 2.98% in 2013 and 17 basis points higher than the 2.78% in 2012.  The decrease in this ratio for 2014 was due to a 2.2% increase in operating expenses, primarily a result of expanded operations due to the B of A acquisition, while average assets grew by 3.1% due to organic loan growth.  The increase in this ratio in 2013 was due to a 7.9% increase in operating expenses, primarily due to the acquisitions over the last two years, without a corresponding increase in average assets due to the balance sheet restructuring undertaken in the first half of 2013.

The efficiency ratio, a performance measurement tool widely used by banks, is defined by the Company as operating expenses (excluding acquisition expenses, litigation settlement charge and intangible amortization) divided by operating income (fully tax-equivalent net interest income plus noninterest income, excluding net securities and debt gains and losses).  Lower ratios are correlated to higher operating efficiency.  The efficiency ratio for 2014 was 1.4 percentage points lower than the 59.3% ratio for 2013 due to a 2.2% increase in operating expenses, as defined above, being smaller than the 4.7% increase in operating income.  The increase in 2014 operating income was comprised of a 2.7% increase in net interest income and a 9.4% increase in noninterest income.  In 2013, the efficiency ratio was 1.9 percentage points higher than 2012 as the 7.9% increase in operating expenses, as defined above, grew at a faster pace than the 4.5% increase in operating income, comprised of a 2.4% increase in net interest income and a 9.9% increase in noninterest income (excluding net securities gains and debt extinguishments costs).

Table 6: Noninterest Expenses
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
(000's omitted)
2014
2013
2012
Salaries and employee benefits
$123,077 
$121,629 
$112,034
Occupancy and equipment
27,948 
27,045 
25,799
Data processing and communications
29,294 
27,186 
23,696
Amortization of intangible assets
4,287 
4,469 
4,607
Legal and professional fees
7,247 
7,008 
7,950
Office supplies and postage
6,270 
6,122 
5,742
Business development and marketing
7,125 
6,815 
5,919
FDIC insurance premiums
3,899 
3,829 
3,804
Acquisition expenses and litigation settlement
2,923 
2,181 
8,247
Other
14,510 
14,971 
13,959
   Total noninterest expenses
$226,580 
$221,255 
$211,757
       
Operating expenses(1) /average assets
2.95% 
2.98% 
2.78%
Efficiency ratio
57.9% 
59.3% 
57.4%
 
(1)Operating expenses are total noninterest expenses excluding acquisition expenses, litigation
    settlement charges and amortization of intangible assets
 
 
 
 
31

 
 
Salaries and employee benefits increased $1.4 million, or 1.2%, in 2014 primarily due to the addition of approximately 40 employees as a result of the B of A acquisition in late 2013, as well as the impact of annual merit increases and higher incentive payments in 2014 based on the achievement of the Company’s annual business objectives, partially offset by lower pension related costs.  Total salaries and employee benefits increased $9.6 million, or 8.6%, in 2013, primarily due to the addition of approximately 145 employees from the HSBC and First Niagara branch acquisitions in the third quarter of 2012, 40 employees as a result of the B of A acquisition in late 2013, as well as the impact of annual merit increases and higher incentive payments in 2013 based on the achievement of the Company’s annual business objectives.  Total full-time equivalent staff at the end of 2014 was 1,945 compared to 1,987 at December 31, 2013 and 1,996 at the end of 2012.

Employee medical expenses decreased $0.8 million, or 8.3%, in 2014 due primarily to a lower level of claims experienced in 2014.  Medical expenses increased $1.7 million in 2013, or 20%, due to a general rise in the cost of medical care, administration and insurance, as well as the additional employees added from the HSBC and First Niagara branch acquisitions in 2012.  This year’s defined benefit retirement plan expense decreased $4.7 million due to the strong asset performance and the increase in the actuarial assumption for liability discount rate from 4.1% to 5.0%.  Defined benefit pension expense in 2013 decreased $0.4 million due to the improved funded status of the pension plan, higher returns on plan assets and the increase in the liability discount.  The 401(k) Plan expense for 2014 increased approximately $0.2 million from 2013 due principally to additional participants being added as a result of the 2013 branch acquisition.  The 401(k) Plan expense increased $0.3 million in 2013 as compared to 2012 due to additional participants being added as a result of the HSBC and First Niagara acquisitions.  The three assumptions that have the largest impact on the calculation of annual pension expense are the discount rate utilized, the rate applied to future compensation increases and the expected rate of return on plan assets.  See Note K to the financial statements for further information about the pension plan.

Total non-personnel noninterest expenses, excluding one-time acquisition expenses, and litigation settlement charges increased $3.1 million, or 3.2%, in 2014, and reflects the additional cost of operating an expanded franchise due to the B of A branch acquisition completed in December 2013.  Data processing and communication expenses increased $2.1 million, or 7.8%, over 2013 levels, due to the higher volume of electronic transaction processing, as well as continued investments in Company-wide technology enhancements.  Business development and marketing increased $0.3 million, or 4.6%, in 2014 and reflects the Company’s investment to expand its exposure and strengthen its market share.  Total non-personnel noninterest expenses, excluding one-time acquisition expenses, litigation settlement, and contract termination charges, increased $6.0 million, or 6.5%, in 2013, and includes a full year of costs from the HSBC and First Niagara branch acquisitions completed in 2012.

Acquisition expenses and litigation settlement charges totaled $2.9 million in 2014, up $0.7 million from similar costs incurred in the prior year, comprised of $0.1 million of acquisition expenses related to the EBS-RMSCO acquisition and a $2.8 million litigation settlement charge pertaining to class action lawsuits involving the sufficiency of consumer notice requirements for certain of the Company’s collateral recovery activities.  The Company contests the allegations and asserted affirmative defenses to the claims, however, the settlement the Company was able to achieve was, in its judgment, a superior outcome for the shareholders when measured against the risks and resources required for litigation.  The settlement is subject to final court approval.  Acquisition expenses for 2013 totaled $2.2 million and related primarily to the acquisition of the B of A branches.  Acquisition expenses for 2012 totaled $5.7 million and were associated with the acquisition of the HSBC and First Niagara branches.  Additionally, 2012 included a charge of $2.5 million from the settlement of a class action lawsuit related to the processing of retail debit card transactions and its impact on overdraft fees.  The Company had considerable affirmative defenses to the claims, however, the settlement the Company was able to achieve was, in its judgment, a superior outcome for shareholders when measured against the cost and the staff resources required for litigation.

The Company continually evaluates all aspects of its operating expense structure and is diligent about identifying opportunities to improve operating efficiencies.  The Company consolidated six of its branch offices during the second half of 2014 and four of its branch offices in 2013.  This realignment reduced market overlap, further strengthened its branch network, and reflects management’s focus on achieving long-term performance improvements through proactive, strategic decision making.

Income Taxes

The Company estimates its income tax expense based on the amount it expects to owe the respective tax authorities, plus the impact of deferred tax items.  Taxes are discussed in more detail in Note I of the Consolidated Financial Statements beginning on page 72.  Accrued taxes represent the net estimated amount due or to be received from taxing authorities.  In estimating accrued taxes, management assesses the relative merits and risks of the appropriate tax treatment of transactions taking into account statutory, judicial and regulatory guidance in the context of the Company’s tax position.  If the final resolution of taxes payable differs from its estimates due to regulatory determination or legislative or judicial actions, adjustments to tax expense may be required.
 
 
 
32

 

 
The effective tax rate for 2014 was 29.6%, compared to 29.0% in 2013, reflective of higher proportional levels of income being generated from fully taxable sources.  The effective tax rate for 2013 was two basis points lower than the 29.2% rate reported in 2012, reflective of generally similar proportional levels of income from both fully taxable and nontaxable sources.

Shareholders’ Equity

Shareholders’ equity ended 2014 at $987.9 million, up $112.1 million, or 12.8%, from one year earlier.  This increase reflects net income generation of $91.4 million, a $57.3 million increase in accumulated other comprehensive income, $9.9 million from the issuance of shares through employee stock plans, and $4.0 million from stock-based compensation.  These increases were partially offset by common stock dividends declared of $47.1 million and net treasury share purchases of $3.3 million.  The change in other comprehensive income was comprised of a $66.8 million increase in the market value adjustment (“MVA”, represents the after-tax, unrealized change in value of available-for-sale securities in the Company’s investment portfolio) due principally to a decrease in long-term interest rates, partially offset by a negative $9.6 million adjustment to the funded status of the Company’s employee retirement plans due primarily to a decrease in the discount rate used to calculated the Company’s liability related to its pension obligations at December 31, 2014 to 4.5%.  These changes in accumulated other comprehensive income contributed to net comprehensive income of $148.6 million in 2014 as compared to a net comprehensive loss of $2.1 million in 2013.  Excluding accumulated other comprehensive income in both 2014 and 2013, capital rose by $54.8 million, or 6.1%.  Shares outstanding increased by 0.3 million during the year as shares issued from employee stock plan activity exceeded share repurchase activity.

Shareholders’ equity ended 2013 at $875.8 million, down $27.0 million, or 3.0%, from one year earlier.  This decrease reflects an $80.9 million decrease in accumulated other comprehensive income and common stock dividends declared of $44.1 million.  These decreases were partially offset by net income of $78.8 million, $15.2 million from the issuance of shares through employee stock plans and $4.0 million from stock-based compensation.  The change in other comprehensive income was comprised of a $101.5 million decrease in the market value adjustment (“MVA”, represents the after-tax, unrealized change in value of available-for-sale securities in the Company’s investment portfolio) due principally to the sale of investment securities during the 2013 and a rise in long-term interest rates, partially offset by a positive $20.6 million adjustment to the funded status of the Company’s employee retirement plans.  These changes in accumulated other comprehensive income resulted in a net comprehensive loss of $2.1 million in 2013 as compared to net comprehensive income of $102.2 million in 2012.  The primary year-over-year driver of the difference was the change in unrealized gains and losses on the available-for-sale investment portfolio, much of which resulted from realizing gains in 2013.  Excluding accumulated other comprehensive income in both 2013 and 2012, capital rose by $53.9 million, or 6.4%.  Shares outstanding increased by 0.8 million during the year added through employee stock plans.

The Company’s ratio of ending Tier 1 capital to quarterly average assets (or tier 1 leverage ratio), the basic measure for which regulators have established a 5% minimum for an institution to be considered “well-capitalized,” increased 67 basis points to end the year at 9.96%.  This was the result of a 9.6% increase in Tier 1 capital, due primarily to the retention of net income, while fourth quarter average net assets (excludes investment market value adjustment, intangible assets net of related deferred tax liabilities and disallowed mortgage service rights) increased at a slower 2.3% rate.  The tangible equity-to-tangible assets ratio (a non-GAAP measure) was 8.92% at the end of 2014 versus 7.68% one year earlier.  The increase was due to common shareholders’ equity increasing at a faster pace than tangible assets, a result of capital growth through income generation and the increase in MVA due to lower year-end interest rates.  The Company manages organic and acquired growth in a manner that enables it to continue to build upon its strong capital base and maintain the Company’s ability to take advantage of future strategic growth opportunities.

Cash dividends declared on common stock in 2014 of $47.1 million represented an increase of 6.8% over the prior year.  This growth was a result of an increase in outstanding shares due to issuances related to employee stock programs and a $0.06 increase in dividends per share for the year. Dividends per share for 2014 of $1.16 represents a 5.5% increase from the $1.10 in 2013, a result of quarterly dividends per share being increased from $0.28 to $0.30 (a 7.1% increase) during the third quarter of 2014 and from $0.27 to $0.28 (a 3.7% increase) in the third quarter of 2013.  The 2014 increase in quarterly dividends marked the 22nd consecutive year of dividend increases for the Company.  The dividend payout ratio for this year was 51.6% compared to 56.0% in 2013, and 54.3% in 2012.  The dividend payout ratio decreased during 2014 because dividends declared increased 6.8% while net income increased at a 15.9% rate.  The payout ratio increased during 2013 because dividends declared increased 5.4% while net income increased at a lower 2.3% rate.


 
33

 


Liquidity

Liquidity risk is a measure of the Company’s ability to raise cash when needed at a reasonable cost and minimize any loss.  The Bank maintains appropriate liquidity levels in both normal operating environments as well as stressed environments.  The Company must be capable of meeting all obligations to its customers at any time and, therefore, the active management of its liquidity position remains an important management role.  The Bank has appointed the Asset Liability Committee to manage liquidity risk using policy guidelines and limits on indicators of potential liquidity risk.  The indicators are monitored using a scorecard with three risk level limits.  These risk indicators measure core liquidity and funding needs, capital at risk and change in available funding sources.  The risk indicators are monitored using such statistics as the core basic surplus ratio, unencumbered securities to average assets, free loan collateral to average assets, loans to deposits, deposits to total funding and borrowings to total funding ratios.

Given the uncertain nature of our customers' demands as well as the Company's desire to take advantage of earnings enhancement opportunities, the Company must have available adequate sources of on and off-balance sheet funds that can be acquired when needed.  Accordingly, in addition to the liquidity provided by balance sheet cash flows, liquidity must be supplemented with additional sources such as credit lines from correspondent banks as well as borrowings from the FHLB and the Federal Reserve Bank of New York.  Other funding alternatives may also be appropriate from time to time, including wholesale and retail repurchase agreements, large certificates of deposit and the brokered CD market.  The primary source of non-deposit funds is FHLB advances, of which $338 million were outstanding at December 31, 2014.

The Bank’s primary sources of liquidity are its liquid assets, as well as unencumbered securities that can be used to collateralize additional funding.  At December 31, 2014, the Bank had $138 million of cash and cash equivalents of which $13 million are interest earning deposits held at the Federal Reserve, FHLB and other correspondent banks.  The Bank also had $845 million in unused FHLB borrowing capacity based on the Company’s quarter-end collateral levels.  Additionally, the Company has $1.4 billion of unencumbered securities that could be pledged at the FHLB or Federal Reserve to obtain additional funding.  There is $25 million available in unsecured lines of credit with other correspondent banks.

The Company’s primary approach to measuring short-term liquidity is known as the Basic Surplus/Deficit model.  It is used to calculate liquidity over two time periods: first, the amount of cash that could be made available within 30 days (calculated as liquid assets less short-term liabilities as a percentage of average assets); and second, a projection of subsequent cash availability over an additional 60 days.  As of December 31, 2014, this ratio was 18.6% for 30-days and 18.5% for 90-days, excluding the Company's capacity to borrow additional funds from the FHLB and other sources.  There is a sufficient amount of liquidity given the Company’s internal policy requirement of 7.5%.

A sources and uses statement is used by the Company to measure intermediate liquidity risk over the next twelve months.  As of December 31, 2014, there was more than enough liquidity available during the next year to cover projected cash outflows.  In addition, stress tests on the cash flows are performed in various scenarios ranging from high probability events with a low impact on the liquidity position to low probability events with a high impact on the liquidity position.  The results of the stress tests as of December 31, 2014 indicate the Bank has sufficient sources of funds for the next year in all stressed scenarios.

To measure longer-term liquidity, a baseline projection of loan and deposit growth for five years is made to reflect how liquidity levels could change over time.  This five-year measure reflects ample liquidity for loan and other asset growth over the next five years.

Though remote, the possibility of a funding crisis exists at all financial institutions.  Accordingly, management has addressed this issue by formulating a Liquidity Contingency Plan, which has been reviewed and approved by both the Board of Directors and the Company’s Asset Liability Management Committee (“ALCO Committee”).  The plan addresses the actions that the Company would take in response to both a short-term and long-term funding crisis.

A short-term funding crisis would most likely result from a shock to the financial system, either internal or external, which disrupts orderly short-term funding operations.  Such a crisis should be temporary in nature and would not involve a change in credit ratings.  A long-term funding crisis would most likely be the result of drastic credit deterioration at the Company.  Management believes that both potential circumstances have been fully addressed through detailed action plans and the establishment of trigger points for monitoring such events.


 
34

 


Intangible Assets

The changes in intangible assets by reporting segment for the year ended December 31, 2014 are summarized as follows:

Table 7: Intangible Assets

 
Balance at
     
Balance at
(000’s omitted)
December 31, 2013
Additions
Amortization
Impairment
December 31, 2014
Banking Segment
         
Goodwill
$364,495
$0
$ 0
$ 0
$364,495
Core deposit intangibles
13,460
0
3,437
0
10,023
Total Banking Segment
377,955
0
3,437
0
374,518
Employee Benefit Services Segment
         
Goodwill
7,836
183
0
0
8,019
Other intangibles
1,506
549
648
0
1,407
Total Employee Benefit Services Segment
9,342
732
648
0
9,426
Wealth Management Segment
         
Goodwill
2,660
0
0
0
2,660
Other intangibles
542
29
202
0
369
Total Wealth Management Segment
3,202
29
202
0
3,029
           
Total
$390,499
$761
$4,287
$ 0
$386,973

Intangible assets at the end of 2014 totaled $387.0 million, a decrease of $3.5 million from the prior year-end due to $4.3 million of amortization during the year, partially offset by $0.8 million of additional intangible assets arising primarily from the EBS-RMSCO acquisition.  Intangible assets consist of goodwill and the value of core deposits and customer relationships that arise from acquisitions.  Goodwill represents the excess cost of an acquisition over the fair value of the net assets acquired.  Goodwill at December 31, 2014 totaled $375.2 million, comprised of $364.5 million related to banking acquisitions and $10.7 million arising from the acquisition of financial services businesses.  Goodwill is subjected to periodic impairment analysis to determine whether the carrying value of the acquired net assets exceeds their fair value, which would necessitate a write-down of goodwill.  The Company completed its goodwill impairment analyses during the first quarters of 2014 and 2013 and no adjustments were necessary for the banking or financial services businesses.  The impairment analysis was based upon discounted cash flow modeling techniques that require management to make estimates regarding the amount and timing of expected future cash flows.  It also requires the selection of a discount rate that reflects the current return requirements of the market in relation to present risk-free interest rates, required equity market premiums and company-specific performance and risk indicators.  Management believes that there is a low probability of future impairment with regard to the goodwill associated with its whole-bank, branch and financial services business acquisitions.

Core deposit intangibles represent the value of non-time deposits acquired in excess of funding that could have been obtained in the capital markets.  Core deposit intangibles are amortized on either an accelerated or straight-line basis over periods ranging from seven to twenty years.  The recognition of customer relationship intangibles arose due to the acquisitions of the trust department of Wilber, CAI, Alliance Benefit Group MidAtlantic, HB&T, Harbridge and the CBNA Insurance Agency.  These assets were determined based on a methodology that calculates the present value of the projected future net income derived from the acquired customer base.  These assets are being amortized on an accelerated basis over periods ranging from seven to twelve years.


 
35

 


Loans

The Company’s loans outstanding, by type, as of December 31 are as follows:

Table 8: Loans Outstanding

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Consumer mortgage
$1,613,384
$1,582,058
$1,448,415
$1,214,621
$1,057,332
Business lending
1,262,484
1,260,364
1,233,944
1,226,439
1,023,286
Consumer indirect
833,968
740,002
647,518
556,955
494,529
Consumer direct
184,028
180,139
171,474
149,170
146,575
Home equity
342,342
346,520
364,225
323,840
304,641
Gross loans
4,236,206
4,109,083
3,865,576
3,471,025
3,026,363
Allowance for loan losses
(45,341)
(44,319)
(42,888)
 (42,213)
(42,510)
Loans, net of allowance for loan losses
$4,190,865
$4,064,764
$3,822,688
$3,428,812
$2,983,853
Daily average of total gross loans
$4,156,840
$3,954,515
$3,628,006
$3,355,286
$3,075,030

As disclosed in Table 8 above, gross loans outstanding of $4.2 billion as of December 31, 2014 increased $127.1 million, or 3.1%, compared to December 31, 2013 as a result of organic growth in the consumer mortgage, consumer indirect, direct and business lending portfolios attributable to the low interest rate environment and continued business development efforts, partially offset by the continued soft demand for home equity loans.  Gross loans outstanding at December 31, 2013 of $4.1 billion increased $243.5 million, or 6.3%, compared to December 31, 2012 as a result of strong organic growth in the consumer mortgage, consumer indirect and consumer direct portfolios.

The compounded annual growth rate (“CAGR”) for the Company’s total loan portfolio between 2009 and 2014 was 6.4%, comprised of approximately 5.0% of organic growth, with the remainder coming from acquisitions.  The greatest overall expansion occurred in the consumer mortgage portfolio, which grew at a 9.1% CAGR.  The consumer indirect and direct segment grew at a compounded annual growth rate of 8.8% from 2009 to 2014.  The business lending segment grew at a compounded annual growth rate of 3.4% driven by acquisitions during the five year period.  The home equity lending segment grew at a compounded annual growth rate of 1.4% from 2009 to 2014, including the impact from acquisitions.
 
The weighting of the components of the Company’s loan portfolio enables it to be highly diversified.  Approximately 70% of loans outstanding at the end of 2014 were made to consumers borrowing on an installment, line of credit or residential mortgage loan basis.  The business lending portfolio is also broadly diversified by industry type as demonstrated by the following distributions at year-end 2014: commercial real estate (24%), healthcare (11%), restaurant & lodging (11%), general services (9%), agriculture (7%), manufacturing (7%), retail trade (8%), construction (5%), wholesale trade (5%) and motor vehicle and parts dealers (4%).  A variety of other industries with less than a 3% share of the total portfolio comprise the remaining 9%.

The consumer mortgage loans include no exposure to Alt-A or other higher-risk mortgage products and are comprised of fixed (98%) and adjustable rate (2%) residential lending.  Volume in this portion of the Company’s loan portfolio has been strong over the last few years due to historically low long-term interest rates and comparatively stable real estate valuations in the Company’s primary markets.  Consumer mortgages increased $31.3 million, or 2.0%, in 2014 and does not include $25.7 million of longer-term, fixed-rate residential mortgages that Company originated and sold, principally to Fannie Mae.  During 2013, the Company originated and sold $25.2 million of residential mortgages. Beginning in the fourth quarter of 2011 through the first quarter of 2013, the Company chose to retain in portfolio the majority of mortgage production.  The Company’s solid performance during a tumultuous period in the overall industry is a reflection of the high quality profile of its portfolio and its ability to successfully meet customer needs at a time when some national mortgage lenders have restricted their lending activities in many of the Company’s markets.  Market interest rates, expected duration, and the Company’s overall interest rate sensitivity profile continue to be the most significant factors in determining whether the Company chooses to retain versus sell and service portions of its new mortgage generation.


 
36

 


The combined total of general-purpose business lending, including agricultural-related and dealer floor plans, as well as mortgages on commercial property, is characterized as the Company’s business lending activity.  The business lending portfolio increased $2.1 million, or 0.2%, in 2014.  Generating organic growth in this segment has remained challenging primarily due to tepid customer demand and highly competitive conditions, resulting in aggressive underwriting and at times undisciplined pricing by our competitors.  These conditions continue to prevail in the small and middle market segments in which the Company operates and, moving forward, the Company anticipates further headwinds as Money Center banks maneuver to increase market share in this space.  Further, the Company proactively managed payout of certain loan relationships that did not provide an appropriate risk adjusted return.  The Company maintains its commitment to generating growth in its business portfolio in a manner that adheres to its twin goals of maintaining strong asset quality and producing profitable margins.  The Company continues to invest in additional personnel, technology, and business development resources to further strengthen its capabilities in this important product category.

The following table shows the maturities and type of interest rates for business and construction loans as of December 31, 2014:

Table 9:  Maturity Distribution of Business and Construction Loans (1)
 
(000's omitted)
Maturing in
One Year or
Less
Maturing After
One but Within
Five Years
Maturing
After Five
Years
Total
Commercial, financial and agricultural
$186,282
$422,028
$634,977
$1,243,287
Real estate – construction
25,121
0
0
25,121
     Total
$211,403
$422,028
$634,977
$1,268,408
         
Fixed interest rates
$31,342
$215,524
$115,685
$362,551
Floating or adjustable interest rates
180,061
206,504
519,292
905,857
     Total
$211,403
$422,028
$634,977
$1,268,408
 
 (1) Scheduled repayments are reported in the maturity category in which the payment is due.
 
Consumer installment loans, both those originated directly (such as personal installment loans and lines of credit), and indirectly (originated predominantly in automobile, marine and recreational vehicle dealerships), increased $97.9 million, or 10.6%, from one year ago.  The volume of new and used vehicles sales to upper-tier credit profile customers in the Company’s primary markets has improved in recent periods.  The Company is focused on maintaining the solid profitability produced by its in-market and contiguous market indirect portfolio, while continuing to pursue its disciplined, long-term approach to expanding its dealer network.  However, the increasingly competitive nature of this market, including the re-emergence of manufacturer captive financing, has resulted in declining indirect loan yields.  Market trends predict continued vehicle sales increases over the prior year levels and this should create the opportunity for the Company to continue to produce solid indirect loan growth.

Home equity loans decreased $4.2 million, or 1.2%, from one year ago, due primarily to home equity loans being paid off or down as part of the above average level of mortgage refinancing activity that occurred over the past 24 months in the low rate environment.  In addition, home equity utilization has been adversely impacted by the heightened level of consumer deleveraging activity that is occurring in response to the continued longer-term slow growth economic conditions.


 
37

 


Asset Quality

The following table presents information concerning nonperforming assets as of December 31:

Table 10: Nonperforming Assets

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Nonaccrual loans
         
   Consumer mortgage
$15,323
$12,560
$11,286
$6,520
$4,737
   Business lending
2,780
4,555
13,691
18,535
9,715
   Consumer indirect
10
14
0
2
0
   Consumer direct
20
4
8
0
0
   Home equity
2,598
2,340
1,375
1,205
926
     Total nonaccrual loans
20,731
19,473
26,360
26,262
15,378
Accruing loans 90+ days delinquent
         
   Consumer mortgage
2,397
1,338
1,818
2,171
2,308
   Business lending
350
164
247
399
247
   Consumer indirect
82
755
73
32
131
   Consumer direct
36
117
71
95
96
   Home equity
241
181
539
393
309
     Total accruing loans 90+ days delinquent
3,106
2,555
2,748
3,090
3,091
Nonperforming loans
         
   Consumer mortgage
17,720
13,898
13,104
8,691
7,045
   Business lending
3,130
4,719
13,938
18,934
9,962
   Consumer indirect
92
769
73
34
131
   Consumer direct
56
121
79
95
96
   Home equity
2,839
2,521
1,914
1,598
1,235
     Total nonperforming loans
23,837
22,028
29,108
29,352
18,469
           
Other real estate (OREO)
1,855
5,060
4,788
2,682
2,011
     Total nonperforming assets
$25,692
$27,088
$33,896
$32,034
$20,480
           
Allowance for loan losses / total loans
1.07%
1.08%
1.11%
1.22%
1.40%
Allowance for legacy loan losses / total legacy loans (1)
1.14%
1.15%
1.21%
1.36%
1.40%
Allowance for loan losses / nonperforming loans
190%
201%
147%
144%
230%
Allowance for legacy loans  / nonperforming legacy loans (1)
221%
234%
171%
197%
230%
Nonperforming loans / total loans
0.56%
0.54%
0.75%
0.85%
0.61%
Legacy nonperforming loans / legacy total loans
0.52%
0.49%
0.71%
0.69%
0.61%
Nonperforming assets / total loans and other real estate
0.61%
0.66%
0.88%
0.92%
0.68%
Delinquent loans (30 days old to nonaccruing) to total loans
1.46%
1.49%
1.92%
1.99%
1.91%
Loan loss provision to net charge-offs
117%
122%
108%
94%
109%
Legacy loan loss provision to net charge-offs (1)
125%
134%
116%
86%
109%
 
(1)Legacy loans exclude loans acquired after January 1, 2009.


 
38

 


The Company places a loan on nonaccrual status when the loan becomes 90 days past due, or sooner if management concludes collection of interest is doubtful, except when, in the opinion of management, it is well-collateralized and in the process of collection.  As shown in Table 10 above, nonperforming loans, defined as nonaccruing loans, accruing loans 90 days or more past due and restructured loans ended 2014 at $23.8 million, an increase of approximately $1.8 million from one year earlier.  The ratio of nonperforming loans to total loans at December 31, 2014 increased two basis points from the prior year to 0.56%.  Excluding nonperforming acquired loans, the ratio of nonperforming loans to total loans at the end of 2014 was 0.52%, an increase of three basis points from the prior year.  The ratio of nonperforming assets (which includes other real estate owned, or “OREO”, in addition to nonperforming loans) to total loans plus OREO decreased to 0.61% at year-end 2014, down five basis points from one year earlier.  The Company’s success at keeping these ratios at favorable levels despite soft economic conditions was the result of continued focus on maintaining strict underwriting standards, early problem recognition, and effective collection and recovery efforts.  At December 31, 2014 OREO was comprised of four commercial real estate properties with a total value of $0.5 million and 29 residential properties with a total value of $1.4 million. This compares to 12 commercial real estate properties with a total value of $3.1 million and 34 residential properties with a total value of $1.9 million at December 31, 2013.  The decrease in OREO balances and the number of properties reflects a general decrease in business lending nonperforming assets and the increased ability to sell properties in 2014, enabling the disposition of one large commercial property. 

Approximately 74% of nonperforming loans at December 31, 2014 are related to the consumer mortgage portfolio.  Collateral values of residential properties within the Company’s market area have generally trended lower over the past few years, although they did not experience the significant decline in values that other parts of the country encountered.  However, the continued soft economic conditions and above average unemployment levels have adversely impacted both consumers and businesses, and have resulted in higher mortgage nonperforming levels.  Additionally, contributing to the increased level of nonperforming consumer mortgages is the greater amount of time required to complete the consumer foreclosure process which is due to new regulatory requirements.  Approximately 13% of the nonperforming loans at December 31, 2014 are related to the business lending portfolio, which is comprised of business loans broadly diversified by industry type.  The level of nonperforming business loans has declined primarily as a result of general economic improvements and maintaining strict underwriting standards.  The remaining 13% percent of nonperforming loans relate to consumer installment and home equity loans.  The allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans ratio, a general measure of coverage adequacy, was 190% at the end of 2014 compared to 201% at year-end 2013 and 147% at December 31, 2012, reflective of the slight increase in the level of nonperforming loans.  Excluding acquired loans, the ratio of allowance for legacy loans to nonperforming legacy loans was 221% at the end of 2014, compared to 234% at year-end 2013 and 171% at December 31, 2012.

Members of senior management, special asset officers, and commercial bankers review all delinquent and nonaccrual loans and OREO regularly, in order to identify deteriorating situations, monitor known problem credits and discuss any needed changes to collection efforts, if warranted.  Based on the group’s consensus, a relationship may be assigned a special assets officer or other senior lending officer to review the loan, meet with the borrowers, assess the collateral and recommend an action plan.  This plan could include foreclosure, restructuring the loans, issuing demand letters or other actions.  The Company’s larger criticized credits are also reviewed on at least a quarterly basis by senior credit administration, special assets and commercial lending management to monitor their status and discuss relationship management plans.  Commercial lending management reviews the entire criticized loan portfolio on a monthly basis.

Total delinquencies, defined as loans 30 days or more past due or in nonaccrual status, finished the current year at 1.46% of total loans outstanding, versus 1.49% at the end of 2013.  As of year-end 2014, total delinquency ratios for commercial loans, consumer installment loans, real estate mortgages and home equity loans were 0.83%, 1.21%, 2.08% and 1.55%, respectively.  These measures were 0.65%, 1.62%, 2.04% and 1.66%, respectively, as of December 31, 2013.  Delinquency levels, particularly in the 30 to 89 days category, tend to be somewhat volatile due to their measurement at a point in time, and therefore management believes that it is useful to evaluate this ratio over a longer period.  The average quarter-end delinquency ratio for total loans in 2014 was 1.32%, as compared to an average of 1.50% in 2013 and 1.80% in 2012, reflective of management’s continued focus on maintaining strict underwriting standards, as well as the effective utilization of its collection and recovery capabilities.

Loans are considered modified in a troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”) when, due to a borrower’s financial difficulties, the Company makes a concession or concessions to the borrower that it would not otherwise consider.  These modifications primarily include, among others, an extension of the term of the loan or granting a period with reduced or no principal and/or interest payments, which can be recaptured through payments made over the remaining term of the loan or at maturity.  Historically, the Company has had very few TDRs.   During 2012, new regulatory guidance was issued by the OCC addressing the accounting of certain loans that have been discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy.  In accordance with this new guidance, loans that have been discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy but not reaffirmed by the borrower are classified as TDRs, irrespective of payment history or delinquency status, even if the repayment terms for the loan have not been otherwise modified and the Company’s lien position against the underlying collateral remains unchanged.  Pursuant to that guidance, the Company records a charge-off equal to any portion of the carrying value that exceeds the net realizable value of the collateral.  As of  December 31, 2014 the Company had 68 loans totaling $2.8 million considered to be nonaccruing TDRs and 157 loans totaling $3.2 million considered to be accruing TDRs as compared to 47 loans totaling $2.0 million considered to be nonaccruing TDRs and 213 loans totaling $3.4 million considered to be accruing TDRs at December 31, 2013.

 
39

 

The changes in the allowance for loan losses for the last five years are as follows:

Table 11: Allowance for Loan Losses Activity

 
Years Ended December 31,
(000's omitted except for ratios)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
           
Allowance for loan losses at beginning of period
$44,319
$42,888
$42,213
$42,510
$41,910
Charge-offs:
         
  Consumer mortgage
1,075
1,012
1,004
748
583
  Business lending
1,596
3,671
5,654
2,964
3,950
  Consumer indirect
6,784
4,544
5,407
4,464
4,279
  Consumer direct
1,595
1,954
1,694
1,273
1,719
  Home equity
765
650
423
265
181
     Total charge-offs
11,815
11,831
14,182
9,714
10,712
Recoveries:
         
  Consumer mortgage
205
36
59
30
71
  Business lending
750
692
1,295
692
730
  Consumer indirect
3,773
3,488
3,551
3,200
2,569
  Consumer direct
846
1,034
821
674
730
  Home equity
85
20
23
85
7
     Total recoveries
5,659
5,270
5,749
4,681
4,107
           
Net charge-offs
6,156
6,561
8,433
5,033
6,605
Provision for loan losses
7,497
7,358
8,715
4,350
7,205
Provision for acquired impaired loans
(319)
634
393
386
0
           
Allowance for loan losses at end of period
$45,341
$44,319
$42,888
$42,213
$42,510
           
Net charge-offs to average loans outstanding:
         
  Consumer mortgage
0.05%
0.06%
0.07%
0.06%
0.05%
  Business lending
0.07%
0.24%
0.36%
0.19%
0.31%
  Consumer indirect
0.38%
0.16%
0.31%
0.24%
0.34%
  Consumer direct
0.40%
0.52%
0.54%
0.39%
0.68%
  Home equity
0.20%
0.18%
0.12%
0.06%
0.06%
  Total loans
0.15%
0.17%
0.23%
0.15%
0.21%

As displayed in Table 11 above, total net charge-offs in 2014 were $6.2 million, down $0.4 million from the prior year due to lower net charge-offs in the business lending, consumer mortgage, and consumer direct portfolios, partially offset by higher levels of net charge-offs in the consumer indirect and home equity portfolios.  Net charge-offs in 2013 were $1.9 million lower than 2012’s level, due to lower charge-offs in the business lending and consumer indirect portfolios, partially offset by higher levels of net charge-offs in the consumer mortgage, consumer direct and home equity portfolios.

Due to the significant increases in average loan balances over time as a result of acquisition and organic growth, management believes that net charge-offs as a percent of average loans (“net charge-off ratio”) offers the most meaningful representation of charge-off trends.  The total net charge-off ratio for 2014 was down two basis points from 2013 and eight basis points from 2012.  Gross charge-offs as a percentage of average loans was 0.28% in 2014, as compared to 0.30% in 2013 and 0.39% in 2012, evidencing management’s continued focus on maintaining strict underwriting standards.  Continued strong recovery efforts were evidenced by recoveries of $5.7 million in 2014, representing 48% of average gross charge-offs for the latest two years, compared to 41% in 2013 and 48% in 2012.

Business loan net charge-offs decreased in 2014, totaling $0.8 million, or 0.07% of average business loans outstanding versus $3.0 million, or 0.24% of the average outstandings in 2013, reflective of the Company’s disciplined risk management and underwriting standards.  Consumer installment loan net charge-offs increased to $3.8 million this year from $2.0 million in 2013, with a net charge-off ratio of 0.38% in 2014 and 0.23% in 2013.  This is reflective of the nearly 45% growth in balances since the end of 2011 as well as lower market resale valuations that hindered consumer installment recovery efforts, which, in 2014, were 62% of average gross charge-offs for the latest two years, compared to 67% in 2013, and 68% in 2012.  The dollar amount of consumer mortgage net charge-offs decreased in 2014, with the net charge-off ratio decreasing one basis point to 0.05%.  Home equity net charges offs increased by $0.1 million to $0.7 million in 2014 while the net charge-off ratio increased two basis points to 0.20%.

 
40

 

Management continually evaluates the credit quality of the Company’s loan portfolio and conducts a formal review of the allowance for loan losses adequacy on a quarterly basis.  The two primary components of the loan review process that are used to determine proper allowance levels are specific and general loan loss allocations.  Measurement of specific loan loss allocations is typically based on expected future cash flows, collateral values and other factors that may impact the borrower’s ability to repay.  Impaired loans greater than $0.5 million are evaluated for specific loan loss allocations.  Consumer mortgages, consumer installment and home equity loans are considered smaller balance homogeneous loans and are evaluated collectively.  The Company considers a loan to be impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect all amounts according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement or the loan is delinquent 90 days or more.

The second component of the allowance establishment process, general loan loss allocations, is composed of two calculations that are computed on the five main loan segments: business lending, consumer direct, consumer indirect, consumer mortgage and home equity.  The first calculation determines an allowance level based on the latest 36 months of historical net charge-off data for each loan category (business loans exclude balances with specific loan loss allocations).  The second calculation is qualitative and takes into consideration eight qualitative environmental factors: levels and trends in delinquencies and impaired loans; levels of and trends in charge-offs and recoveries; trends in volume and terms of loans; effects of any changes in risk selection and underwriting standards, and other changes in lending policies, procedure, and practices; experience, ability, and depth of lending management and other relevant staff; national and local economic trends and conditions; industry conditions; and effects of changes in credit concentrations.  The allowance levels computed from the specific and general loan loss allocation methods are combined with unallocated allowances, if any, to derive the required allowance for loan losses to be reflected on the Consolidated Statement of Condition.  As it has in prior periods, the Company strives to refine and enhance its loss evaluation and estimation processes continually.

The loan loss provision is calculated by subtracting the previous period allowance for loan losses, net of the interim period net charge-offs, from the current required allowance level.  This provision is then recorded in the income statement for that period. Members of senior management and the Audit/Compliance/Risk Management Committee of the Board of Directors review the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses quarterly.  Management is committed to continually improving the credit assessment and risk management capabilities of the Company and has dedicated the resources necessary to ensure advancement in this critical area of operations.

Acquired loans are recorded at their acquisition date fair values and, therefore, are excluded from the calculation of loan loss reserves as of the acquisition date.  To the extent there is a decrease in the present value of cashflows from the acquired impaired loans after the date of acquisition, the Company records a provision for potential losses.  During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company reversed $0.3 million of its provision for loan losses related to acquired impaired loans as the value received at closure for certain loans was greater than the value they were being carried on the books.  In 2013 and 2012, an additional $0.6 million and $0.4 million, respectively, of provision for loan losses related to the acquired impaired loans was recorded.

For acquired loans that are not deemed impaired at acquisition, a fair value adjustment is recorded that includes both credit and interest rate considerations.  Subsequent to the purchase date, the methods utilized to estimate the required allowance for loan losses for these loans is similar to originated loans, however, the Company records a provision for loan losses only when the required allowance exceeds any remaining purchased discounts.  For the 2014 year the Company recorded a provision for loan losses on acquired non-impaired loans of $0.6 million.  During 2013 and 2012, the Company recorded a provision for loan losses on acquired non-impaired loans of $0.3 million and $0.7 million, respectively, with $0.5 million of 2012’s amount being recorded in the third quarter for loan pools acquired in that quarter where the net fair value of the pool was deemed greater than its par value at acquisition.

The allowance for loan losses increased to $45.3 million at the end 2014 from $44.3 million as of year-end of 2013.  The $1.0 million increase was primarily due to organic loan growth.  The allowance for legacy loan losses increased $1.6 million as growth in the loan portfolio was partially offset by changes in the composition of the loan portfolio from higher risk business loans to lower risk consumer mortgage.  The ratio of the allowance for loan losses to total loans decreased one basis point to 1.07% for year-end 2014 as compared to 1.08% for 2013 and 1.11% for 2012.  The ratio of allowance for loan losses to total legacy loans decreased one basis point to 1.14% for 2014 as compared 2013.  Management believes the year-end 2014 allowance for loan losses to be adequate in light of the probable losses inherent in the Company’s loan portfolio.

The loan loss provision for legacy loans of $6.9 million in 2014, which was equal to the prior year, and reflects management’s assessment of the probable losses in the loan portfolio, as discussed above.  The loan loss provision as a percentage of average loans was 0.17% in 2014 as compared to 0.20% in 2013 and 0.25% in 2012.  The loan loss provision was 117% of net charge-offs this year versus 122% in 2013 and 108% in 2012, reflective of the assessed risk in the portfolio.

 
41

 


The following table sets forth the allocation of the allowance for loan losses by loan category as of the end of the years indicated, as well as the percentage of loans in each category to total loans.  This allocation is based on management’s assessment, as of a given point in time, of the risk characteristics of each of the component parts of the total loan portfolio and is subject to changes when the risk factors of each component part change.  The allocation is not indicative of either the specific amounts of the loan categories in which future charge-offs may be taken, nor should it be taken as an indicator of future loss trends.  The allocation of the allowance to each category does not restrict the use of the allowance to absorb losses in any category.

Table 12: Allowance for Loan Losses by Loan Type

   
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2010
     
Loan
   
Loan
   
Loan
   
Loan
   
Loan
(000's omitted except for ratios)
 
Allowance
Mix
 
Allowance
Mix
 
Allowance
Mix
 
Allowance
Mix
 
Allowance
Mix
Consumer mortgage
 
$10,286
38.1%
 
$8,994
38.5%
 
$7,070
37.5%
 
$4,651
35.0%
 
$2,451
34.9%
Business lending
 
15,787
29.7%
 
17,507
30.5%
 
18,013
31.6%
 
20,574
34.8%
 
22,326
33.8%
Consumer indirect
 
11,544
19.7%
 
10,248
18.0%
 
9,606
16.7%
 
8,960
16.1%
 
9,922
16.4%
Consumer direct
 
3,083
4.3%
 
3,181
4.4%
 
3,303
4.4%
 
3,290
4.3%
 
3,977
4.8%
Home equity
 
2,701
8.1%
 
1,830
8.4%
 
1,451
9.4%
 
1,130
9.3%
 
689
10.1%
Acquired impaired loans
 
173
0.1%
 
530
0.2%
 
779
0.4%
 
386
0.5%
 
0
 
Unallocated
 
1,767
   
2,029
   
2,666
   
3,222
   
3,145
 
Total
 
$45,341
100.0%
 
$44,319
100.0%
 
$42,888
100.0%
 
$42,213
100.0%
 
$42,510
100.0%

As demonstrated in Table 12 above and discussed previously, business lending and consumer installment by their nature carries higher credit risk than residential real estate, and as a result these loans carry allowance for loan losses that cover a higher percentage of their total portfolio balances.  As in prior years, the unallocated allowance is maintained for inherent losses in the portfolio that is not reflected in the historical loss ratios, model imprecision, and for acquired loan portfolios in the process of being fully integrated at year-end.  The unallocated allowance decreased from $2.7 million at year-end 2012 to $2.0 million at year-end 2013 to $1.8 million at December 31, 2014.  The general declines in the unallocated portion of the allowance, as well as changes in year-over-year allowance allocations reflect management’s continued refinement of its loss estimation techniques.  However, given the inherent imprecision in the many estimates used in the determination of the allocated portion of the allowance, management deliberately remained cautious and conservative in establishing the overall allowance for loan losses.  Management considers the allocated and unallocated portions of the allowance for loan losses to be prudent and reasonable.  Furthermore, the Company’s allowance is general in nature and is available to absorb losses from any loan category.

Funding Sources

The Company utilizes a variety of funding sources to support the earning-asset base as well as to achieve targeted growth objectives.  Overall funding is comprised of three primary sources that possess a variety of maturity, stability, and price characteristics; deposits of individuals, partnerships and corporations (nonpublic deposits), municipal deposits that are collateralized for amounts not covered by FDIC insurance (public funds), and external borrowings.  The average daily amount of deposits and the average rate paid on each of the following deposit categories are summarized below for the years indicated:

Table 13: Average Deposits

   
2014
 
2013
 
2012
   
Average
Average
 
Average
Average
 
Average
Average
(000's omitted, except rates)
 
Balance
Rate Paid
 
Balance
Rate Paid
 
Balance
Rate Paid
Noninterest checking deposits
 
$1,249,807
0.00%
 
$1,119,935
0.00%
 
$989,631
0.00%
Interest checking deposits
 
1,334,745
0.03%
 
1,206,242
0.03%
 
1,036,249
0.06%
Regular savings deposits
 
1,039,173
0.08%
 
982,519
0.10%
 
806,310
0.16%
Money market deposits
 
1,493,900
0.16%
 
1,425,961
0.17%
 
1,327,092
0.38%
Time deposits
 
845,035
0.54%
 
940,095
0.74%
 
1,062,307
1.06%
  Total deposits
 
$5,962,660
0.14%
 
$5,674,752
0.19%
 
$5,221,589
0.35%
                   

As displayed in Table 13 above, total average deposits for 2014 equaled $5.96 billion, up $287.9 million, or 5.1%, from the prior year.  Excluding the impact of the 2013 branch acquisition, average deposits increased $47.0 million, or 0.8%, as compared to 2013.  Consistent with the Company’s focus on expanding core account relationships and reduced customer demand for time deposits, average non-acquired, non-time (“core”) deposit balances grew $200.7 million, or 4.2%, as compared to 2013 while non-acquired time deposits balances declined $153.7 million, or 16.4%.  This shift in mix also reflects the diminished rate differential between core and time deposits in the low interest rate environment and helped lower the cost of deposits, including the impact of non-interest checking deposits, to 0.14% in 2014 as compared to 0.19% for 2013.  Average deposits in 2013 were up $453.2 million, or 8.7%, from 2012, comprised of a $575.4 million, or 13.8%, increase in core deposits, and a $122.2 million, or 11.5%, decrease in time deposits.  Excluding the impact of the HSBC, and First Niagara acquisitions, average deposits increased $79.1 million, or 1.6%, as compared to 2012.
 
 
 
42

 
 
The Company’s funding composition continues to benefit from a high level of nonpublic deposits, which reached an all-time high in 2014 with an average balance of $5.4 billion, an increase of $242.7 million, or 4.7%, over the comparable 2013 period.  Excluding the impact of the 2013 branch acquisition, average nonpublic deposits increased $2.2 million during 2014.  Nonpublic, core deposits are frequently considered to be a bank’s most attractive source of funding because they are generally stable, do not need to be collateralized, have a relatively low cost, generate solid fee income, and provide a strong customer base for which a variety of loan, deposit and other financial service-related products can be cross-sold.

Full-year average public fund deposits increased $45.2 million, or 8.3%, during 2014 to $587.0 million.  Excluding the impact of the branch acquisition of 2013, average public fund deposits increased $44.8 million, or 8.3%, during 2014.  Public fund deposit balances tend to be more volatile than nonpublic deposits because they are heavily impacted by the seasonality of tax collection and fiscal spending patterns, as well as the longer-term financial position of the local government entities, which can change from year to year.  However, the Company has many strong, long-standing relationships with municipal entities throughout its markets and the diversified core deposits held by these customers have provided an attractive and comparatively stable funding source over an extended time period.  The Company is required to collateralize all local government deposits in excess of FDIC coverage with marketable securities from its investment portfolio.  Because of this stipulation, as well as the competitive bidding nature of municipal time deposits, management considers this funding source to share some of the attributes of external borrowings and thus prices these products based on external borrowing rates.

The mix of average deposits has been changing throughout the last several years.  The weighting of core (interest checking, noninterest checking, savings and money market accounts) has increased, while time deposits’ weighting has decreased.  This change in deposit mix reflects the Company’s focus on expanding core account relationships and customers’ preference for unrestricted accounts in the current low rate environment.  The average balance for time deposit accounts decreased from 22.7% of total average deposits in the first quarter of 2012 to 13.2% of total average deposits for the fourth quarter of 2014.  Correspondingly, average core deposit balances have increased from 77.3% in the first quarter of 2012 to 86.8% in the fourth quarter of 2014.  This shift in mix, combined with lower average interest rates in all interest-bearing deposit product categories caused the cost of interest-bearing deposits to decline to 0.17% in 2014, as compared to 0.24% in 2013 and 0.43% in 2012.  The total cost of deposit funding, which includes demand deposits, also declined in 2014 to 0.14%, versus 0.19% in 2013, benefiting from the 11.6% increase in non-interest bearing checking average balances.

The remaining maturities of time deposits in amounts of $100,000 or more outstanding as of December 31 are as follows:

Table 14: Time Deposit > $100,000 Maturities

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
Less than three months
$33,106
$50,233
Three months to six months
33,392
43,880
Six months to one year
37,506
48,578
Over one year
65,883
63,724
  Total
$169,887
$206,415

Borrowing sources for the Company include the FHLB and Federal Reserve Bank of New York, as well as access to the brokered CD and repurchase markets through established relationships with primary market security dealers.  The Company also had $102 million in floating-rate subordinated debt outstanding at the end of 2014 that is held by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts.

As shown in Table 15, year-end 2014 external borrowings totaled $440.1 million, an increase of $196.1 million from the end of 2013.  Short term borrowings from the FHLB were used to fund the purchase of investment securities and cover other liquidity needs during 2014.  As part of the ongoing asset liability management process, the Company had been evaluating the opportunity to restructure certain portions of the balance sheet.  During the first half of 2013, the Company initiated a balance sheet restructuring program through the sale of certain longer duration investment securities and retired $501.6 million of the company’s existing FHLB borrowings with $63.5 million of early extinguishment costs.  These actions enhanced the Company’s regulatory capital position while positively impacting expected future net interest income generation.  During the second and third quarter of 2013, the Company used $300 million of short-term borrowing to purchase U.S. Treasury securities in anticipation of the excess funding expected from the pending branch acquisition in the fourth quarter of 2013.  In December, in conjunction with the liquidation of the trust preferred CDOs and sale of treasury securities, the Company extinguished an additional $226 million of FHLB advances with $23.8 million of early extinguishment costs.
 
 

 
43

 


External borrowings averaged $405.4 million, or 6.4% of total funding sources for 2014, as compared to $567.1 million, or 9.1% of total funding sources for 2013.  This ratio decreased as the Company early extinguished FHLB term advances during 2013, partially offset by the use of short-term borrowings from the FHLB to fund the purchase of investment securities and liquidity needs in 2014.  As shown in Table 16 at the end of 2014, the Company had $338.0 million, or 77% of external borrowings, with remaining terms of one year or less as compared to 58% of external borrowings maturing within one year at December 31, 2013.

As displayed in Table 3 on page 28, the overall mix of funding continued to shift in 2014.  The percentage of funding derived from deposits increased to 93.6% in 2014 from 90.9% in 2013 and 84.6% in 2012.  During 2014 average borrowings decreased 28.5% while average deposits increased 5.1%.

The following table summarizes the outstanding balance of borrowings of the Company as of December 31:

Table 15: Borrowings

(000's omitted, except rates)
2014
2013
2012
FHLB overnight advance
$338,000
$141,900
$0
FHLB term advances
0
0
728,034
Capital lease obligation
0
13
27
Subordinated debt held by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts
102,122
102,097
102,073
      Balance at end of period
$440,122
$244,010
$830,134
       
Daily average during the year
$405,411
$567,079
$947,454
Maximum month-end balance
$521,211
$830,099
$1,259,932
Weighted-average rate during the year
0.89%
2.70%
3.46%
Weighted-average year-end rate
0.79%
1.22%
3.81%

The following table shows the contractual maturities of various obligations as of December 31, 2014:

Table 16: Maturities of Contractual Obligations

   
Maturing
Maturing
   
 
Maturing
After One
After Three
   
 
Within
Year but
Years but
Maturing
 
 
One Year
Within
Within
After
 
(000's omitted)
Or Less
Three Years
Five Years
Five Years
Total
FHLB overnight advance
$338,000
$0
$0
$0
$338,000
Subordinated debt held by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts
0
0
0
102,527
102,527
Interest on borrowings
2,429
4,846
4,846
35,918
48,039
Purchase commitments
1,868
0
0
0
1,868
Operating leases
5,497
10,002
6,603
3,568
25,670
     Total
$347,794
$14,848
$11,449
$142,013
$516,104

Financial Instruments with Off-Balance Sheet Risk

The Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance-sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers.  These financial instruments consist primarily of commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit.  Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to customers, generally having fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses that may require payment of a fee.  These commitments consist principally of unused commercial and consumer credit lines.  Standby letters of credit generally are contingent upon the failure of the customer to perform according to the terms of an underlying contract with a third party.  The credit risks associated with commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit are essentially the same as that involved with extending loans to customers and are subject to normal credit policies.  Collateral may be obtained based on management’s assessment of the customer’s creditworthiness.  The fair value of these commitments is immaterial for disclosure.

 
44

 


The contractual amounts of these off-balance sheet financial instruments as of December 31 were as follows:

Table 17: Off-Balance Sheet Financial Instruments

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
Commitments to extend credit
$733,827
$704,904
Standby letters of credit
23,916
24,449
     Total
$757,743
$729,353

Investments

The objective of the Company’s investment portfolio is to hold low-risk, high-quality earning assets that provide favorable returns and provide another effective tool to actively manage its asset/liability position in order to maximize future net interest income opportunities.  This must be accomplished within the following constraints: (a) implementing certain interest rate risk management strategies which achieve a relatively stable level of net interest income; (b) providing both the regulatory and operational liquidity necessary to conduct day-to-day business activities; (c) considering investment risk-weights as determined by the regulatory risk-based capital guidelines; and (d) generating a favorable return without undue compromise of the other requirements.

The carrying value of the Company’s investment portfolio increased $294.2 million during 2014 to end the year at $2.51 billion.  The book value (excluding unrealized gains and losses) of available-for-sale investments increased $180.7 million from December 31, 2013.  During 2014, the Company purchased $224.6 million of U.S. Treasury securities at an average yield of 2.40% along with $63.7 million of obligations of state and political subdivisions at an average yield of 5.15% and $22.2 million of government agency mortgage-backed securities at an average rate of 2.83%.  Offsetting these purchases were $137.1 million of maturities, calls and collections.

As part of the ongoing asset liability management process, the Company had been evaluating the opportunity to restructure certain portions of the balance sheet.  During the first quarter of 2013, the Company initiated a balance sheet restructuring program through the sale of certain longer duration investment securities and retired a portion of the Company’s existing FHLB borrowings.  During the first half of 2013, the Company sold $648.7 million of U.S. Treasury and Agency securities, realizing $63.8 million of gains that supported the retirement of $501.6 million of FHLB borrowings.  These actions enhanced the Company’s regulatory capital position and reduced the expected duration of the investment portfolio, while positively impacting expected future net interest income generation.  During the second and third quarters of 2013, the Company purchased $525 million of U.S. Treasury securities in anticipation of the excess funding expected from the pending branch acquisition and certain other expected cash flows.

In late December 2013, the Company sold its entire portfolio, $56.2 million, of bank and insurance company issued trust preferred collateralized debt obligation (CDO) securities in response to the uncertainties created by the announcement of the final rules implementing Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act, commonly known as the “Volcker Rule”, recognizing a $15.5 million loss.  In conjunction with the liquidation of the trust preferred CDOs, the Company extinguished $226.4 million of FHLB term advances and sold $417.6 million of U.S. Treasury securities previously classified as held-to-maturity at a gain of $32.4 million.  The Company also reinvested the net cash proceeds of $246 million created from these transactions into U.S. Treasury securities with similar blended durations to the assets sold in order to mitigate the net interest income impact of the security sales and debt extinguishment.  As a result of the securities sold from the held-to-maturity classification, the remaining unsold securities within the held-to-maturity classification were transferred to the available-for-sale classification prior to December 31, 2013.  As a result of the transaction, the Company did not use the held-to-maturity classification in 2014.

Average investment balances including cash equivalents (book value basis) for 2014 decreased $29.3 million, or 1.2%, versus the prior year driven by the balance sheet restructure in the first half of 2013.  Investment interest income (FTE basis) in 2014 was $5.0 million, or 5.6%, lower than the prior year as a result of the lower average balances in the portfolio and because of a 16 basis point decrease in the average investment yield from 3.58% to 3.42%.  During 2014 market interest rates continued to be low, and as a result, cash flows from higher rate maturing investments were reinvested at lower interest rates.  The investments purchased during 2014 had a weighted average yield of 3.01%.

The investment portfolio has limited credit risk due to the composition continuing to heavily favor U.S. Treasuries, U.S. Agency debentures, U.S. Agency mortgage-backed pass-throughs, U.S. Agency CMOs and municipal bonds.  The U.S. Treasury and Agency debentures, U.S. Agency mortgage-backed pass-throughs and U.S. Agency CMOs are all AAA-rated (highest possible rating) by Moody’s and AA+ by Standard and Poor’s.  The majority of the municipal bonds are A rated or higher.  The portfolio does not include any private label mortgage-backed securities (MBSs) or private label collateralized mortgage obligations.  The overall mix of securities within the portfolio over the last year has changed, with an increase in the proportion of U.S. Treasury and Agency securities and a decrease in the proportion of obligations of state and political subdivisions, government agency mortgage-backed securities and other securities.
 
 
45

 
 
The net pre-tax unrealized market value gain on the available-for-sale investment portfolio as of December 31, 2014 was $75.0 million, as compared to a pre-tax market value loss of $31.0 million one year earlier.  This increase is indicative of the interest rate movements during the respective time periods and the changes in the size and composition of the portfolio.
 
The following table sets forth the amortized cost and market value for the Company's investment securities portfolio:

Table 18: Investment Securities

     2014    2013   2012
   
Amortized
   
Amortized
   
Amortized
 
   
Cost/Book
Fair
 
Cost/Book
Fair
 
Cost/Book
Fair
(000's omitted)
 
Value
Value
 
Value
Value
 
Value
Value
Held-to-Maturity Portfolio:
                 
  U.S. Treasury and agency securities
 
$0
$0
 
$0
$0
 
$548,634
$607,715
  Obligations of state and political subdivisions
 
0
0
 
0
0
 
65,742
71,592
  Government agency mortgage-backed securities
 
0
0
 
0
0
 
20,578
21,657
  Corporate debt securities
 
0
0
 
0
0
 
2,924
2,977
  Other securities
 
0
0
 
0
0
 
16
16
     Total held-to-maturity portfolio
 
0
0
 
0
0
 
637,894
703,957
                   
Available-for-Sale Portfolio:
                 
  U.S. Treasury and agency securities
 
1,479,134
1,517,733
 
1,252,332
1,212,147
 
988,217
1,079,257
  Obligations of state and political subdivisions
 
645,398
671,903
 
665,441
668,982
 
629,883
662,892
  Government agency mortgage-backed securities
 
228,971
237,728
 
250,431
254,978
 
253,013
269,951
  Pooled trust preferred securities
 
0
0
 
0
0
 
61,979
49,600
  Corporate debt securities
 
26,803
27,091
 
26,932
27,587
 
24,136
25,357
  Government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
 
17,330
18,025
 
21,779
22,048
 
32,359
33,935
  Marketable equity securities
 
250
445
 
250
421
 
351
402
     Total available-for-sale portfolio
 
2,397,886
2,472,925
 
2,217,165
2,186,163
 
1,989,938
2,121,394
                   
Other Securities:
                 
  Federal Reserve Bank common stock
 
16,050
16,050
 
16,050
16,050
 
16,050
16,050
  FHLB common stock
 
19,553
19,553
 
12,053
12,053
 
38,111
38,111
  Other equity securities
 
4,446
4,446
 
4,459
4,459
 
5,078
5,078
    Total other securities
 
40,049
40,049
 
32,562
32,562
 
59,239
59,239
                   
     Total
 
$2,437,935
$2,512,974
 
$2,249,727
$2,218,725
 
$2,687,071
$2,884,590


 
 

 
46

 


The following table sets forth as of December 31, 2014, the maturities of investment securities and the weighted-average yields of such securities, which have been calculated on the cost basis, weighted for scheduled maturity of each security:

Table 19: Maturities of Investment Securities

 
Maturing
Maturing
Maturing
 
Total
 
Within
After One Year
After Five Years
Maturing
Amortized
 
One Year
But Within
But Within
After
Cost/Book
(000's omitted, except rates)
or Less
Five Years
Ten Years
Ten Years
Value
Available-for-Sale Portfolio:
         
U.S. Treasury and agency securities
$20,947
$1,000
$1,457,187
$0
$1,479,134
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
28,441
131,582
238,109
247,266
645,398
Government agency mortgage-backed securities (2)
0
1,110
5,888
221,973
228,971
Corporate debt securities
9,998
13,976
2,829
0
26,803
Government agency collateralized mortgage obligations (2)
0
0
38
17,292
17,330
  Available-for-sale portfolio
$59,386
$147,668
$1,704,051
$486,531
$2,397,636
Weighted-average yield (1)
3.59%
2.55%
2.53%
3.62%
2.78%

 
(1) Weighted-average yields are an arithmetic computation of income (not fully tax-equivalent adjusted) divided by book balance;
     they may differ from the yield to maturity, which considers the time value of money.
 
(2) Mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations are listed based on the contractual maturity.  Actual
     maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay certain obligations with
     or without penalties.

Impact of Inflation and Changing Prices

The Company’s financial statements have been prepared in terms of historical dollars, without considering changes in the relative purchasing power of money over time due to inflation.  Unlike most industrial companies, virtually all of the assets and liabilities of a financial institution are monetary in nature.  As a result, interest rates have a more significant impact on a financial institution's performance than the effect of general levels of inflation.  Interest rates do not necessarily move in the same direction or in the same magnitude as the prices of goods and services.  Notwithstanding this, inflation can directly affect the value of loan collateral, real estate in particular.
 
New Accounting Pronouncements

See “New Accounting Pronouncements” Section of Note A of the notes to the consolidated financial statements on page 60 for additional accounting pronouncements.

Forward-Looking Statements

This document contains comments or information that constitute forward-looking statements (within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995), which involve significant risks and uncertainties.  Actual results may differ materially from the results discussed in the forward-looking statements.  Moreover, the Company’s plans, objectives and intentions are subject to change based on various factors (some of which are beyond the Company’s control).  Factors that could cause actual results to differ from those discussed in the forward-looking statements include:  (1) risks related to credit quality, interest rate sensitivity and liquidity;  (2) the strength of the U.S. economy in general and the strength of the local economies where the Company conducts its business;  (3) the effect of, and changes in, monetary and fiscal policies and laws, including interest rate policies of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System;  (4) inflation, interest rate, market and monetary fluctuations;  (5) the timely development of new products and services and customer perception of the overall value thereof (including features, pricing and quality) compared to competing products and services;  (6) changes in consumer spending, borrowing and savings habits;  (7) technological changes; (8) any acquisitions or mergers that might be considered or consummated by the Company and the costs and factors associated therewith;  (9) the ability to maintain and increase market share and control expenses;  (10) the effect of changes in laws and regulations (including laws and regulations concerning taxes, banking, securities and insurance) and accounting principles generally accepted in the United States;  (11) changes in the Company’s organization, compensation and benefit plans and in the availability of, and compensation levels for, employees in its geographic markets;  (12) the costs and effects of litigation and of any adverse outcome in such litigation; (13) other risk factors outlined in the Company’s filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission from time to time; (14) changes imposed by regulatory agencies to increase the Company’s capital requirements; and (15) the success of the Company at managing the risks of the foregoing.

The foregoing list of important factors is not exclusive.  Such forward-looking statements speak only as of the date on which they are made and the Company does not undertake any obligation to update any forward-looking statement, whether written or oral, to reflect events or circumstances after the date on which such statement is made.  If the Company does update or correct one or more forward-looking statements, investors and others should not conclude that the Company will make additional updates or corrections with respect thereto or with respect to other forward-looking statements.
 
 
 
47

 
 
Item 7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

Market risk is the risk of loss in a financial instrument arising from adverse changes in market rates, prices or credit risk.  Credit risk associated with the Company's loan portfolio has been previously discussed in the asset quality section of the MD&A.  Management believes that the tax risk of the Company's municipal investments associated with potential future changes in statutory, judicial and regulatory actions is minimal.  Treasury, agency, mortgage-backed and CMO securities issued by government agencies comprise 72% of the total portfolio and are currently rated AAA by Moody’s Investor Services and AA+ by Standard & Poor’s.  Municipal and corporate bonds account for 28% of the total portfolio, of which, 98% carry a minimum rating of A.  The remaining 2% of the portfolio is comprised of other investment grade securities.  The Company does not have material foreign currency exchange rate risk exposure.  Therefore, almost all the market risk in the investment portfolio is related to interest rates.

The ongoing monitoring and management of both interest rate risk and liquidity, in the short and long term time horizons is an important component of the Company's asset/liability management process, which is governed by limits established in the policies reviewed and approved annually by the Company’s Board of Directors.  The Board of Directors delegates responsibility for carrying out the policies to the ALCO Committee, which typically meets each month.  The committee is made up of the Company's senior management as well as regional and line-of-business managers who oversee specific earning asset classes and various funding sources.  As the Company does not believe it is possible to reliably predict future interest rate movements, it has maintained an appropriate process and set of measurement tools, which enables it to identify and quantify sources of interest rate risk in varying rate environments.  The primary tool used by the Company in managing interest rate risk is income simulation.

While a wide variety of strategic balance sheet and treasury yield curve scenarios are tested on an ongoing basis, the following reflects the Company's projected net interest income sensitivity over the subsequent twelve months based on:

●  
Asset and liability levels using December 31, 2014 as a starting point.

●  
There are assumed to be conservative levels of balance sheet growth, low to mid single digit growth in loans and deposits, while using the cash flows from investment contractual maturities and prepayments to repay short-term capital market borrowings or reinvest into securities or cash equivalents.

●  
The prime rate and federal funds rates are assumed to move up 200 basis points over a 12-month period while moving the long end of the treasury curve to spreads over federal funds that are more consistent with historical norms (normalized yield curve).  In the 0 basis point model, the prime and federal funds rates remain at current levels while moving the long end of the curve to levels over federal funds using spreads at a time when the yield curve was flat.  Deposit rates are assumed to move in a manner that reflects the historical relationship between deposit rate movement and changes in the federal funds rate.

●  
Cash flows are based on contractual maturity, optionality, and amortization schedules along with applicable prepayments derived from internal historical data and external sources.

Net Interest Income Sensitivity Model
 
Change in interest rates
 
Calculated annualized
increase (decrease) in
projected net interest
income at December 31,
2014
+200 basis points
($4,918,000)
0 basis points
($524,000)

The modeled net interest income (NII) decreases in a rising rate environment from a flat rate scenario.  The decrease is largely a result of assumed deposit and funding costs increasing faster than the re-pricing of corresponding assets.  In the short term (year 1) the assumed increase of deposit rates in the rising rate environment temporarily outweighs the benefit of earning asset yields increasing to higher levels.  However, over a longer time period (years 2-5), the growth in NII improves significantly in a rising rate environment as lower yielding assets mature and are replaced at higher rates.   

In the 0 basis point model, the Bank shows interest rate risk exposure if the yield curve continues to flatten.  Net interest income declines during the first twelve months largely from additional investment cash flows that are assumed to repay short term advances.  Corresponding deposit rates are assumed to remain constant.  Despite Fed Funds trading near 0%, the Company believes long-term treasury rates could potentially fall further in this scenario, and thus, the model tests the impact of this lower treasury rate scenario.
 
 
 
48

 

The analysis does not represent a Company forecast and should not be relied upon as being indicative of expected operating results.  These hypothetical estimates are based upon numerous assumptions: the nature and timing of interest rate levels (including yield curve shape), prepayments on loans and securities, deposit decay rates, pricing decisions on loans and deposits, reinvestment/replacement of asset and liability cash flows, and other factors.  While the assumptions are developed based upon current economic and local market conditions, the Company cannot make any assurances as to the predictive nature of these assumptions, including how customer preferences or competitor influences might change.  Furthermore, the sensitivity analysis does not reflect actions that the ALCO Committee might take in responding to or anticipating changes in interest rates.

Item 8.  Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

The following consolidated financial statements and independent registered public accounting firm’s report of Community Bank System, Inc. are contained on pages 50 through 90 of this item.

●  
Consolidated Statements of Condition,
December 31, 2014 and 2013

●  
Consolidated Statements of Income,
Years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012

●  
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income,
Years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012

●  
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders' Equity,
Years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012

●  
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows,
Years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012

●  
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,
December 31, 2014

●  
Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

●  
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Quarterly Selected Data (Unaudited) for 2014 and 2013 are contained on page 93.

 
49

 

COMMUNITY BANK SYSTEM, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CONDITION
(In Thousands, Except Share Data)

 
December 31,
 
2014
2013
Assets:
   
   Cash and cash equivalents
$138,396
$149,647
     
   Available-for-sale investment securities (cost of $2,397,886 and $2,217,165, respectively)
2,472,925
2,186,163
     
   Other securities, at cost
40,049
32,562
     
   Loans held for sale, at fair value
1,042
728
     
   Loans
4,236,206
4,109,083
   Allowance for loan losses
(45,341)
(44,319)
     Net loans
4,190,865
4,064,764
     
   Goodwill
375,174
374,991
   Core deposit intangibles, net
10,023
13,460
   Other intangibles, net
1,776
2,048
     Intangible assets, net
386,973
390,499
     
   Premises and equipment, net
93,633
93,636
   Accrued interest and fees receivable
24,645
25,475
   Other assets
140,912
152,390
     
        Total assets
$7,489,440
$7,095,864
     
Liabilities:
   
   Noninterest-bearing deposits
$1,324,661
$1,203,346
   Interest-bearing deposits
4,610,603
4,692,698
      Total deposits
5,935,264
5,896,044
     
  Borrowings
338,000
141,913
  Subordinated debt held by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts
102,122
102,097
  Accrued interest and other liabilities
126,150
79,998
     Total liabilities
6,501,536
6,220,052
     
Commitments and contingencies (See Note N)
   
     
Shareholders' equity:
   
  Preferred stock $1.00 par value, 500,000 shares authorized, 0 shares issued
0
0
  Common stock, $1.00 par value, 75,000,000 shares authorized; 41,606,422 and
   
     41,213,491 shares issued, respectively
41,606
41,213
  Additional paid-in capital
409,984
396,528
  Retained earnings
525,985
481,732
  Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
30,720
(26,546)
  Treasury stock, at cost (858,701 and 782,173 shares, respectively)
(20,391)
(17,115)
     Total shareholders' equity
987,904
875,812
     
     Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
$7,489,440
$7,095,864









The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

 
50

 

COMMUNITY BANK SYSTEM, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
(In Thousands, Except Per-Share Data)

 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2014
2013
2012
Interest income:
     
  Interest and fees on loans
$185,527
$188,197
$192,710
  Interest and dividends on taxable investments
50,247
54,995
65,165
  Interest and dividends on nontaxable investments
20,446
20,967
23,525
     Total interest income
256,220
264,159
281,400
       
Interest expense:
     
  Interest on deposits
8,191
10,732
18,162
  Interest on borrowings
1,124
12,813
30,098
  Interest on subordinated debt held by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts
2,477
2,520
2,716
     Total interest expense
11,792
26,065
50,976
       
Net interest income
244,428
238,094
230,424
Provision for loan losses
7,178
7,992
9,108
Net interest income after provision for loan losses
237,250
230,102
221,316
       
Noninterest income:
     
  Deposit service fees
52,756
49,357
46,064
  Other banking services
5,814
5,245
4,069
  Employee benefit services
42,580
38,596
35,946
  Wealth management services
17,870
15,550
12,876
  Gain on sales of investment securities, net
0
80,768
291
  Loss on debt extinguishments
0
(87,336)
0
     Total noninterest income
119,020
102,180
99,246
       
Noninterest expenses:
     
  Salaries and employee benefits
123,077
121,629
112,034
  Occupancy and equipment
27,948
27,045
25,799
  Data processing and communications
29,294
27,186
23,696
  Amortization of intangible assets
4,287
4,469
4,607
  Legal and professional fees
7,247
7,008
7,950
  Office supplies and postage
6,270
6,122
5,742
  Business development and marketing
7,125
6,815
5,919
  FDIC insurance premiums
3,899
3,829
3,804
  Acquisition expenses
123
2,181
5,747
  Other expenses
17,310
14,971
16,459
     Total noninterest expenses
226,580
221,255
211,757
       
Income before income taxes
129,690
111,027
108,805
Income taxes
38,337
32,198
31,737
Net income
$91,353
$78,829
$77,068
       
Basic earnings per share
$2.24
$1.96
$1.95
Diluted earnings per share
$2.22
$1.94
$1.93







 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

 
51

 

COMMUNITY BANK SYSTEM, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
(In Thousands)
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2014
2013
2012
       
Pension and other post retirement obligations:
     
Amortization of actuarial (losses)/gains included in net periodic pension cost, gross
($13,904)
$35,395
($3,786)
Tax effect
5,374
(13,841)
1,469
Amortization of actuarial (losses)/gains included in net periodic pension cost, net
(8,530)
21,554
(2,317)
       
Amortization of prior service cost included in net periodic pension cost, gross
(1,698)
(1,502)
(970)
Tax effect
657
588
376
 Amortization of prior service cost included in net periodic pension cost, net
(1,041)
(914)
(594)
       
Other comprehensive (loss)/income related to pension and other post retirement obligations, net of taxes
(9,571)
20,640
(2,911)
       
Unrealized gains on securities:
     
Net unrealized holding gains/(losses) arising during period, gross
106,040
(79,899)
46,236
Tax effect
(39,203)
30,385
(17,978)
Net unrealized holding gains/(losses) arising during period, net
66,837
(49,514)
28,258
       
Reclassification adjustment for net gains included in net income, gross
0
(80,768)
(291)
Tax effect
0
29,756
113
Reclassification adjustment for net loss included in net income, net
0
(51,012)
(178)
       
Unrealized holding loss, net related to securities transferred from held-to-maturity to available-for-sale, gross
0
(1,791)
0
Tax effect
0
797
0
Reclassification adjustment for net loss transferred from held-to-maturity to available-for-sale, gross
0
(994)
0
       
Other comprehensive income/(loss) related to unrealized gains/(losses) on available-for-sale securities, net of taxes
66,837
(101,520)
28,080
       
Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax
57,266
(80,880)
25,169
Net income
91,353
78,829
77,068
Comprehensive income/(loss)
$148,619
($2,051)
$102,237
 
As of December 31,
 
2014
2013
2012
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income By Component:
     
Unrealized loss for pension and other postretirement obligations
($26,941)
($11,339)
($45,232)
Tax effect
10,225
4,194
17,447
Net unrealized loss for pension and other postretirement obligations
(16,716)
(7,145)
(27,785)
       
Unrealized gain/(loss) on available-for-sale securities
75,039
(31,002)
131,456
Tax effect
(27,603)
11,601
(49,337)
Net unrealized (loss)/gain on available-for-sale securities
47,436
(19,401)
82,119
       
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)
$30,720
($26,546)
$54,334







The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

 
52

 

COMMUNITY BANK SYSTEM, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
Years ended December 31, 2012, 2013 and 2014
(In Thousands, Except Share Data)
 
       
Accumulated
   
 
Common Stock
Additional
 
Other
   
 
Shares
Amount
Paid-in
Retained
Comprehensive
Treasury
 
 
Outstanding
Issued
Capital
Earnings
(Loss)/Income
Stock
Total
               
Balance at December 31, 2011
36,986,409
$37,795
$313,501
$411,805
$29,165
($17,683)
$774,583
Net income
     
77,068
   
77,068
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
       
25,169
 
25,169
Dividends declared:
             
   Common, $1.06 per share
     
(41,855)
   
(41,855)
Common stock issued under
 
 
 
   
 
 
   employee stock plan,              
   including tax benefits of $1,524 509,724 496
8,457
    275
9,228
Stock-based compensation
   
3,668
     
3,668
Common stock issuance
2,129,800
2,130
52,787
     
54,917
Balance at December 31, 2012
39,625,933
40,421
378,413
447,018
54,334
(17,408)
902,778
Net income
     
78,829
   
78,829
Other comprehensive loss, net of tax
       
(80,880)
 
(80,880)
Dividends declared:
             
   Common, $1.10 per share
     
(44,115)
   
(44,115)
Common stock issued under
 
 
 
   
 
 
   employee stock plan,              
   including tax benefits of $1,825  805,385 792 14,154     293 15,239  
Stock-based compensation
   
3,961
     
3,961
Balance at December 31, 2013
40,431,318
41,213
396,528
481,732
(26,546)
(17,115)
875,812
Net income
     
91,353
   
91,353
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
       
57,266
 
57,266
Dividends declared:
             
   Common, $1.16 per share
     
(47,100)
   
(47,100)
Common stock issued under
 
 
 
   
 
 
    employee stock plan,              
    including tax benefits of $2,068 399,013 393 9,463     133 9,989  
Stock-based compensation
   
3,993
     
3,993
Treasury stock purchased
(123,000)
       
(4,368)
(4,368)
Treasury stock sold
40,390
       
959
959
Balance at December 31, 2014
40,747,721
$41,606
$409,984
$525,985
$30,720
($20,391)
$987,904
               










The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

 
53

 

COMMUNITY BANK SYSTEM, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(In Thousands of Dollars)
 
     
Years Ended December 31,
 
2014
2013
2012
Operating activities:
     
  Net income
$91,353
$78,829
$77,068
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:
     
     Depreciation
13,082
12,236
11,482
     Amortization of intangible assets
4,287
4,469
4,607
     Net accretion/amortization on securities, loans and borrowings
(3,533)
(5,959)
(9,379)
     Stock-based compensation
3,993
3,961
3,668
     Provision for loan losses
7,178
7,992
9,108
     Provision for deferred income taxes
7,461
7,130
12,032
     Amortization of mortgage servicing rights
444
529
687
     Income from bank-owned life insurance policies
(1,037)
(1,066)
(1,121)
     Gain on sales of investment securities, net
0
(80,768)
(291)
     Loss on debt extinguishments
0
87,336
0
     Net (gain) loss on sale of loans and other assets
(154)
257
247
     Net change in loans originated for sale
137
(515)
608
     Change in other assets and liabilities
(10)
(11,247)
(292)
       Net cash provided by operating activities
123,201
103,184
108,424
Investing activities:
     
  Proceeds from sales of available-for-sale investment securities
0
713,694
5,378
  Proceeds from sales of held-to-maturity investment securities
0
450,032
0
  Proceeds from maturities of available-for-sale investment securities
137,282
234,021
215,223
  Proceeds from maturities of held-to-maturity investment securities
0
31,595
28,340
  Proceeds from maturities of other securities
13
26,649
278
  Purchases of available-for-sale investment securities
(310,517)
(923,588)
(752,891)
  Purchases of held-to-maturity investment securities
0
(8,308)
(110,925)
  Purchases of other securities
(7,500)
0
(615)
  Net change in loans
(137,207)
(248,962)
(239,174)
  Cash received for acquisitions, net of cash acquired of $0, $291,990, and $5,510, respectively
(924)
291,980
600,972
  Purchases of premises and equipment, net
(13,376)
(13,855)
(10,846)
       Net cash (used in)/provided by investing activities
(332,229)
553,258
(264,260)
Financing activities:
     
  Net change in deposits
39,220
(35,451)
34,832
  Net change in borrowings, net of payments of $13, $815,384 and $220
196,087
(673,484)
(220)
  Issuance of common stock
9,989
15,239
64,145
  Purchases of treasury stock
(4,368)
0
0
  Sales of treasury stock
959
0
0
  Cash dividends paid
(46,178)
(43,482)
(40,765)
  Tax benefits from share-based payment arrangements
2,068
1,825
1,524
       Net cash provided by/(used in) financing activities
197,777
(735,353)
59,516
Change in cash and cash equivalents
(11,251)
(78,911)
(96,320)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
149,647
228,558
324,878
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
$138,396
$149,647
$228,558
Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information:
     
  Cash paid for interest
$11,937
$30,141
$51,541
  Cash paid for income taxes
29,457
23,648
16,462
Supplemental disclosures of noncash financing and investing activities:
     
  Dividends declared and unpaid
12,254
11,332
10,699
  Transfers from loans to other real estate
2,546
8,325
5,059
  Transfer of investment securities from held-to-maturity to available-for-sale
0
198,890
0
  Acquisitions:
     
     Fair value of assets acquired, excluding acquired cash and intangibles
164
3,678
165,885
     Fair value of liabilities assumed
0
303,494
798,031

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

 
54

 

COMMUNITY BANK SYSTEM, INC.

 
NOTE A:  SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
Nature of Operations
Community Bank System, Inc. (the “Company”) is a single bank holding company which wholly-owns five consolidated subsidiaries: Community Bank, N.A. (the “Bank”), Benefit Plans Administrative Services, Inc. (“BPAS”), CFSI Closeout Corp. (“CFSICC”), First of Jermyn Realty Co. (“FJRC”), and Town & Country Agency LLC (“T&C”).  BPAS owns four subsidiaries, Benefit Plans Administrative Services, LLC (“BPA”), Harbridge Consulting Group, LLC (“Harbrdge”), BPAS Trust Company of Puerto Rico; and Hand Benefits & Trust, Inc. (“HB&T”), which owns Hand Securities Inc. (“HSI”).  BPAS provides administration, consulting and actuarial services to sponsors of employee benefit plans.  CFSICC, FJRC and T&C are inactive companies.  The Company also wholly-owns two unconsolidated subsidiary business trusts formed for the purpose of issuing mandatorily-redeemable preferred securities which are considered Tier I capital under regulatory capital adequacy guidelines (see Note P).

As of December 31, 2014, the Bank operated 182 full service branches under the Community Bank, N.A. name throughout 35 counties of Upstate New York and six counties of Northeastern Pennsylvania offering a range of commercial and retail banking services.  The Bank owns the following subsidiaries: CBNA Insurance Agency, Inc. (“CBNA Insurance”), CBNA Preferred Funding Corporation (“PFC”), CBNA Treasury Management Corporation (“TMC”), Community Investment Services, Inc. (“CISI”), First Liberty Service Corp. (“FLSC”), Nottingham Advisors, Inc. (“Nottingham”), Brilie Corporation (“Brilie”), and Western Catskill Realty, LLC (“WCR”).  CBNA Insurance is a full-service insurance agency offering primarily property and casualty products.  PFC primarily acts as an investor in residential real estate loans.  TMC provides cash management, investment, and treasury services to the Bank.  CISI provides broker-dealer and investment advisory services.  FLSC provides banking-related services to the Pennsylvania branches of the Bank.  Nottingham provides asset management services to individuals, corporate pension and profit sharing plans, and foundations.  Brilie and WCR are inactive companies.

Principles of Consolidation
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its wholly-owned subsidiaries.  All intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

Variable Interest Entities (“VIE”) are required to be consolidated by a company if it is determined the company is the primary beneficiary of a VIE.  The primary beneficiary of a VIE is the enterprise that has: (1) the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance, and (2) the obligation to absorb losses of the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE or the right to receive benefits of the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE.  The Company’s wholly-owned subsidiaries, Community Statutory Trust III and Community Capital Trust IV, are VIEs for which the Company is not the primary beneficiary.  Accordingly, the accounts of these entities are not included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

Critical Accounting Estimates in the Preparation of Financial Statements
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period.  Actual results could differ from those estimates.  Critical accounting estimates include the allowance for loan losses, actuarial assumptions associated with the pension, post-retirement and other employee benefit plans, the provision for income taxes, investment valuation and other-than-temporary impairment, the carrying value of goodwill and other intangible assets, and acquired loan valuations.

Risk and Uncertainties
In the normal course of its business, the Company encounters economic and regulatory risks.  There are three main components of economic risk: interest rate risk, credit risk and market risk.  The Company is subject to interest rate risk to the degree that its interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice at different speeds, or on different basis, from its interest-earning assets.  The Company’s primary credit risk is the risk of default on the Company’s loan portfolio that results from the borrowers’ inability or unwillingness to make contractually required payments.  Market risk reflects potential changes in the value of collateral underlying loans, the fair value of investment securities, and loans held for sale.

The Company is subject to regulations of various governmental agencies.  These regulations can change significantly from period to period.  The Company also undergoes periodic examinations by the regulatory agencies which may subject it to further changes with respect to asset valuations, amounts of required loan loss allowances, and operating restrictions resulting from the regulators’ judgments based on information available to them at the time of their examinations.

 
55

 

Revenue Recognition
The Company recognizes income on an accrual basis. CISI recognizes fee income when investment and insurance products are sold to customers.  Nottingham provides asset management services to brokerage firms and clients and recognizes income ratably over the contract period during which service is performed.  Revenue from BPA’s administration and recordkeeping services is recognized ratably over the service contract period.  Revenue from consulting and actuarial services is recognized when services are rendered.  CBNA Insurance recognizes commission revenue at the later of the effective date of the insurance policy, or the date on which the policy premium is billed to the customer.  At that date, the earnings process has been completed and the impact of refunds for policy cancellations can be reasonably estimated to establish reserves. The reserve for policy cancellations is based upon historical cancellation experience adjusted for known circumstances. All intercompany revenue and expense among related entities are eliminated in consolidation.

Cash and Cash Equivalents
For purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, amounts due from banks and highly liquid investments with original maturities of less than 90 days.  The carrying amounts reported in the balance sheet for cash and cash equivalents approximate those assets’ fair values.

Investment Securities
The Company has classified its investments in debt and equity securities as held-to-maturity or available-for-sale.  Held-to-maturity securities are those for which the Company has the positive intent and ability to hold until maturity, and are reported at cost, which is adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts.  As discussed further in Note D, during 2013 the Company reclassified its held-to-maturity portfolio to available-for-sale and consequently did not use the held-to-maturity classification in 2014.  Securities classified as available-for-sale are reported at fair value with net unrealized gains and losses reflected as a separate component of shareholders' equity, net of applicable income taxes.  None of the Company's investment securities have been classified as trading securities at December 31, 2014.  Certain equity securities are stated at cost and include restricted stock of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (“Federal Reserve”) and Federal Home Loan Bank of New York (“FHLB”).

Fair values for investment securities are based upon quoted market prices, where available.  If quoted market prices are not available, fair values are based upon quoted market prices of comparable instruments, or a discounted cash flow model using market estimates of interest rates and volatility.

The Company conducts an assessment of all securities in an unrealized loss position to determine if other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) exists on a quarterly basis. An unrealized loss exists when the current fair value of an individual security is less than its amortized cost basis.  The OTTI assessment considers the security structure, recent security collateral performance metrics, if applicable, external credit ratings, failure of the issuer to make scheduled interest or principal payments, judgment about and expectations of future performance, and relevant independent industry research, analysis and forecasts. The severity of the impairment and the length of time the security has been impaired is also considered in the assessment.  The assessment of whether an OTTI decline exists is performed on each security, regardless of the classification of the security as available-for-sale or held-to-maturity and involves a high degree of subjectivity and judgment that is based on the information available to management at a point in time.
 
An OTTI loss must be recognized for a debt security in an unrealized loss position if there is intent to sell the security or it is more likely than not the Company will be required to sell the security prior to recovery of its amortized cost basis. In this situation, the amount of loss recognized in income is equal to the difference between the fair value and the amortized cost basis of the security. Even if management does not have the intent, and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the securities, an evaluation of the expected cash flows to be received is performed to determine if a credit loss has occurred. For debt securities, a critical component of the evaluation for OTTI is the identification of credit-impaired securities, where the Company does not expect to receive cash flows sufficient to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the security.  In the event of a credit loss, only the amount of impairment associated with the credit loss would be recognized in income. The portion of the unrealized loss relating to other factors, such as liquidity conditions in the market or changes in market interest rates, is recorded in accumulated other comprehensive loss.

Equity securities are also evaluated to determine whether the unrealized loss is expected to be recoverable based on whether evidence exists to support a realizable value equal to or greater than the amortized cost basis. If it is probable that the amortized cost basis will not be recovered, taking into consideration the estimated recovery period and the ability to hold the equity security until recovery, OTTI is recognized in earnings equal to the difference between the fair value and the amortized cost basis of the security.

The specific identification method is used in determining the realized gains and losses on sales of investment securities and OTTI charges.  Premiums and discounts on securities are amortized and accreted, respectively, on the interest method basis over the period to maturity or estimated life of the related security.  Purchases and sales of securities are recognized on a trade date basis.


 
56

 

Loans
Loans are stated at unpaid principal balances, net of unearned income.  Mortgage loans held for sale are carried at fair value and are included in loans held for sale on the balance sheet. Fair values for variable rate loans that reprice frequently are based on carrying values.  Fair values for fixed rate loans are estimated using discounted cash flows and interest rates currently being offered for loans with similar terms to borrowers of similar credit quality.  The carrying amount of accrued interest approximates its fair value.

Interest on loans is accrued and credited to operations based upon the principal amount outstanding.  Nonrefundable loan fees and related direct costs are deferred and included in the loan balances where they are amortized over the life of the loan as an adjustment to loan yield using the effective yield method.  Premiums and discounts on purchased loans are amortized using the effective yield method over the life of the loans.

Acquired loans
Acquired loans are initially recorded at their acquisition date fair values.  The carryover of allowance for loan losses is prohibited as any credit losses in the loans are included in the determination of the fair value of the loans at the acquisition date. Fair values for acquired loans are based on a discounted cash flow methodology that involves assumptions and judgments as to credit risk, prepayment risk, liquidity risk, default rates, loss severity, payment speeds, collateral values and discount rate.

Acquired impaired loans
Acquired loans that have evidence of deterioration in credit quality since origination and for which it is probable, at acquisition, that the Company will be unable to collect all contractually required payments are accounted for as impaired loans under ASC 310-30.  The excess of undiscounted cash flows expected at acquisition over the estimated fair value is referred to as the accretable discount and is recognized into interest income over the remaining life of the loans using the interest method. The difference between contractually required payments at acquisition and the undiscounted cash flows expected to be collected at acquisition is referred to as the non-accretable discount. The non-accretable discount represents estimated future credit losses and other contractually required payments that the Company does not expect to collect. Subsequent decreases in expected cash flows are recognized as impairments through a charge to the provision for credit losses resulting in an increase in the allowance for loan losses. Subsequent improvements in expected cash flows result in a recovery of previously recorded allowance for loan losses or a reversal of a corresponding amount of the non-accretable discount, which the Company then reclassifies as an accretable discount that is recognized into interest income over the remaining life of the loans using the interest method.

Acquired loans that met the criteria for non-accrual of interest prior to acquisition may be considered performing upon acquisition, regardless of whether the customer is contractually delinquent, if the Company can reasonably estimate the timing and amount of the expected cash flows on such loans and if the Company expects to fully collect the new carrying value of the loans. As such, the Company may no longer consider the loan to be non-accrual or non-performing and may accrue interest on these loans, including the impact of any accretable discount.

Acquired non-impaired loans
Acquired loans that do not meet the requirements under ASC 310-30 are considered acquired non-impaired loans. The difference between the acquisition date fair value and the outstanding balance represents the fair value adjustment for a loan and includes both credit and interest rate considerations. Fair value adjustments may be discounts (or premiums) to a loan’s cost basis and are accreted (or amortized) to net interest income (or expense) over the loan’s remaining life in accordance with ASC 310- 20. Fair value adjustments for revolving loans are accreted (or amortized) using a straight line method. Term loans are accreted (or amortized) using the constant effective yield method.

Subsequent to the purchase date, the methods used to estimate the allowance for loan losses for the acquired non-impaired loans is consistent with the policy described below.  However, the Company compares the net realizable value of the loans to the carrying value, for loans collectively evaluated for impairment.  The carrying value represents the net of the loan’s unpaid principal balance and the remaining purchase discount (or premium) that has yet to be accreted into interest income.  When the carrying value exceeds the net realizable value, an allowance for loan losses is recognized.
 
Impaired and Other Nonaccrual Loans
The Company places a loan on nonaccrual status when the loan becomes 90 days past due (or sooner, if management concludes collection is doubtful), except when, in the opinion of management, it is well-collateralized and in the process of collection.  A loan may be placed on nonaccrual status earlier than ninety days past due if there is deterioration in the financial position of the borrower or if other conditions of the loan so warrant. When a loan is placed on nonaccrual status, uncollected accrued interest is reversed against interest income and the amortization of nonrefundable loan fees and related direct costs is discontinued. Interest income during the period the loan is on nonaccrual status is recorded on a cash basis after recovery of principal is reasonably assured. Nonaccrual loans are returned to accrual status when management determines that the borrower’s performance has improved and that both principal and interest are collectible.  This generally requires a sustained period of timely principal and interest payments and a well-documented credit evaluation of the borrower’s financial condition.


 
57

 


A loan is considered modified in a troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”) when, due to a borrower’s financial difficulties, the Company makes a concession(s) to the borrower that it would not otherwise consider.  These modifications may include, among others, an extension for the term of the loan, or granting a period when interest–only payments can be made with the principal payments and interest caught up over the remaining term of the loan or at maturity.  Generally, a nonaccrual loan that has been modified in a TDR remains on nonaccrual status for a period of 12 months to demonstrate that the borrower is able to meet the terms of the modified loan.  If the borrower’s ability to meet the revised payment schedule is uncertain, the loan remains on nonaccrual status.
 
During 2012, new regulatory guidance was issued by the OCC addressing the accounting of certain loans that have been discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy.  In accordance with this new guidance, loans that have been discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy but not reaffirmed by the borrower are classified as TDRs, irrespective of payment history or delinquency status, even if the repayment terms for the loan have not been otherwise modified.  The Company’s lien position against the underlying collateral remains unchanged.  Pursuant to that guidance, the Company records a charge-off equal to any portion of the carrying value that exceeds the net realizable value of the collateral.

Commercial loans greater than $0.5 million are evaluated individually for impairment.  A loan is considered impaired, based on current information and events, if it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect the scheduled payments of principal or interest when due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement.  The measurement of impaired loans is generally based upon the present value of expected future cash flows or the fair value of the collateral, if the loan is collateral-dependent.

The Company’s charge-off policy by loan type is as follows:
 
●  
Business lending loans are generally charged-off to the extent outstanding principal exceeds the fair value of estimated proceeds from collection efforts, including liquidation of collateral.  The charge-off is recognized when the loss becomes reasonably quantifiable.
●  
Consumer installment loans are generally charged-off to the extent outstanding principal balance exceeds the fair value of collateral, and are recognized by the end of the month in which the loan becomes 90 days past due.
●  
Consumer mortgage and home equity loans are generally charged-off to the extent outstanding principal exceeds the fair value of the property, less estimated costs to sell, and are recognized when the loan becomes 180 days past due.

Allowance for Loan Losses
Management continually evaluates the credit quality of the Company’s loan portfolio, and performs a formal review of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses on a quarterly basis.  The allowance reflects management’s best estimate of probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio.  Determination of the allowance is subjective in nature and requires significant estimates.   The Company’s allowance methodology consists of two broad components - general and specific loan loss allocations.

The general loan loss allocation is composed of two calculations that are computed on five main loan segments:  business lending, consumer installment - direct, consumer installment - indirect, home equity and consumer mortgage.  The first calculation is quantitative and determines an allowance level based on the latest 36 months of historical net charge-off data for each loan class (commercial loans exclude balances with specific loan loss allocations).  The second calculation is qualitative and takes into consideration eight qualitative environmental factors:  levels and trends in delinquencies and impaired loans; levels of and trends in charge-offs and recoveries; trends in volume and terms of loans; effects of any changes in risk selection and underwriting standards, and other changes in lending policies, procedures, and practices; experience, ability, and depth of lending management and other relevant staff; national and local economic trends and conditions; industry conditions; and effects of changes in credit concentrations.    A component of the qualitative calculation is the unallocated allowance for loan loss.  The qualitative and quantitative calculations are added together to determine the general loan loss allocation.  The specific loan loss allocation relates to individual commercial loans that are both greater than $0.5 million and in a nonaccruing status with respect to interest.  Specific loan losses are based on discounted estimated cash flows, including any cash flows resulting from the conversion of collateral or collateral shortfalls.  The allowance levels computed from the specific and general loan loss allocation methods are combined with unallocated allowances and allowances needed for acquired loans to derive the total required allowance for loan losses to be reflected on the Consolidated Statement of Condition.

Loan losses are charged off against the allowance, while recoveries of amounts previously charged off are credited to the allowance.  A provision for loan losses is charged to operations based on management’s periodic evaluation of factors previously mentioned.

Intangible Assets
Intangible assets include core deposit intangibles, customer relationship intangibles and goodwill arising from acquisitions. Core deposit intangibles and customer relationship intangibles are amortized on either an accelerated or straight-line basis over periods ranging from seven to 20 years. The initial and ongoing carrying value of goodwill and other intangible assets is based upon discounted cash flow modeling techniques that require management to make estimates regarding the amount and timing of expected future cash flows.  It also requires use of a discount rate that reflects the current return requirements of the market in relation to present risk-free interest rates, required equity market premiums, peer volatility indicators, and company-specific risk indicators.
 
 
 
58

 
 
The Company evaluates goodwill for impairment on an annual basis, or more often if events or circumstances indicate there may be impairment.  The implied fair value of a reporting unit’s goodwill is compared to its carrying amount and the impairment loss is measured by the excess of the carrying value over fair value.  The fair value of each reporting unit is compared to the carrying amount of that reporting unit in order to determine if impairment is indicated.
 
Premises and Equipment
Premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation.  Computer software costs that are capitalized only include external direct costs of obtaining and installing the software.  The Company has not developed any internal use software.  Depreciation is calculated using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets.  Useful lives range from three to 10 years for equipment; three to seven years for software and hardware; and 10 to 40 years for building and building improvements.  Land improvements are depreciated over 20 years and leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of the term of the respective lease plus any optional renewal periods that are reasonably assured or life of the asset. Maintenance and repairs are charged to expense as incurred.

Other Real Estate
Other real estate owned is comprised of properties acquired through foreclosure, or by deed in lieu of foreclosure.  These assets are carried at fair value less estimated costs of disposal.  At foreclosure, if the fair value, less estimated costs to sell, of the real estate acquired is less than the Company’s recorded investment in the related loan, a write-down is recognized through a charge to the allowance for loan losses.  Any subsequent reduction in value is recognized by a charge to income.  Operating costs associated with the properties are charged to expense as incurred.  At December 31, 2014 and 2013, other real estate amounted to $1.9 million and $5.1 million, respectively, and is included in other assets.

Mortgage Servicing Rights
Originated mortgage servicing rights are recorded at their fair value at the time of sale of the underlying loan, and are amortized in proportion to and over the period of estimated net servicing income or loss.  The Company uses a valuation model that calculates the present value of future cash flows to determine the fair value of servicing rights.  In using this valuation method, the Company incorporates assumptions that market participants would use in estimating future net servicing income, which includes estimates of the servicing cost per loan, the discount rate, and prepayment speeds.  The carrying value of the originated mortgage servicing rights is included in other assets and is evaluated quarterly for impairment using these same market assumptions.  The amount of impairment recognized is the amount by which the carrying value of the capitalized servicing rights for a stratum exceeds estimated fair value.  Impairment is recognized through a valuation allowance.

Treasury Stock
Repurchases of shares of the Company’s common stock are recorded at cost as a reduction of shareholders’ equity.  Reissuance of shares of treasury stock is recorded at average cost.

Income Taxes
The Company and its subsidiaries file a consolidated federal income tax return.  Provisions for income taxes are based on taxes currently payable or refundable as well as deferred taxes that are based on temporary differences between the tax basis of assets and liabilities and their reported amounts in the financial statements.  Deferred tax assets and liabilities are reported in the financial statements at currently enacted income tax rates applicable to the period in which the deferred tax assets and liabilities are expected to be realized or settled.

Benefits from tax positions should be recognized in the financial statements only when it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained upon examination by the appropriate taxing authority having full knowledge of all relevant information. A tax position meeting the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold should be measured at the largest amount of benefit for which the likelihood of realization upon ultimate settlement exceeds 50 percent.

Retirement Benefits
The Company provides defined benefit pension benefits to eligible employees and post-retirement health and life insurance benefits to certain eligible retirees.  The Company also provides deferred compensation and supplemental executive retirement plans for selected current and former employees, officers, and directors.  Expense under these plans is charged to current operations and consists of several components of net periodic benefit cost based on various actuarial assumptions regarding future experience under the plans, including discount rate, rate of future compensation increases and expected return on plan assets.
 
Assets Under Management or Administration
Assets held in fiduciary or agency capacities for customers are not included in the accompanying consolidated statements of condition as they are not assets of the Company.  All fees associated with providing asset management services are recorded on an accrual basis of accounting and are included in noninterest income.

Advertising
Advertising costs amounting to approximately $3.2 million, $3.0 million and $2.6 million for the years ending December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, are nondirect response in nature and expensed as incurred.
 
 
 
59

 

 
Earnings Per Share
Using the two-class method, basic earnings per common share is computed based upon net income available to common shareholders divided by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during each period, which excludes the outstanding unvested restricted stock as they contain nonforfeitable rights to dividends.  Diluted earnings per share is computed using the weighted average number of common shares determined for the basic earnings per common share computation plus the dilutive effect of stock options using the treasury stock method.  Stock options where the exercise price is greater than the average market price of common shares were not included in the computation of earnings per diluted share as they would have been anti-dilutive.

Stock-based Compensation
Companies are required to measure and record compensation expense for stock options and other share-based payments on the instruments’ fair value on the date of grant.  The Company uses the modified prospective method.  Under this method, expense is recognized for awards that are granted, modified, or settled after December 31, 2005, as well as for unvested awards that were granted prior to January 1, 2006.  Stock-based compensation expense is recognized ratably over the requisite service period for all awards (see Note L).
 
Fair Values of Financial Instruments
The Company determines fair values based on quoted market values where available or on estimates using present values or other valuation techniques.  Those techniques are significantly affected by the assumptions used, including the discount rate and estimates of future cash flows.  In that regard, the derived fair value estimates cannot be substantiated by comparison to independent markets and, in many cases, could not be realized in immediate settlement of the instrument.  Certain financial instruments and all nonfinancial instruments are excluded from this disclosure requirement.  Accordingly, the aggregate fair value amounts presented do not represent the underlying value of the Company.  The fair values of investment securities, loans, deposits, and borrowings have been disclosed in Note R.

Reclassifications
Certain reclassifications have been made to prior years’ balances to conform to the current year presentation.
 
Subsequent Event
On February 24, 2015, the Company announced that it had entered into a definitive agreement to acquire Oneida Financial Corp. (“Oneida”), parent company of Oneida Savings Bank headquartered in Oneida, NY for approximately $142 million in Company stock and cash.  The acquisition will extend the Company’s Central New York banking service area and complement the Company’s existing non-banking service capacity in the insurance, benefits administration and wealth management businesses.  Upon the completion of the merger, Community Bank will add 12 branch locations and approximately $800 million of assets, including loans of $370 million and $690 million of deposits.  The acquisition is expected to close during the third quarter of 2015, pending both customary regulatory and Oneida shareholder approval.  The Company expects to incur certain one-time, transaction-related costs in 2015.

New Accounting Pronouncements
In January 2014, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2014-04, Receivables – Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors (Subtopic 310-40):  Reclassification of Residential Real Estate Collateralized Consumer Mortgage Loans upon Foreclosure.  This new guidance clarifies when an in substance repossession or foreclosure occurs, and requires all creditors who obtain physical possession (resulting from an in substance repossession or foreclosure) of residential real estate property collateralizing a consumer mortgage loan in satisfaction of a receivable to reclassify the collateralized mortgage loan such that the loan should be derecognized and the collateral asset recognized. This guidance is effective prospectively for the Company for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2014.  The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606).  This new guidance supersedes the revenue recognition requirements in ASC 605, Revenue Recognition, and is based on the principle that revenue is recognized to depict the transfer of goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods and services. The ASU also requires additional disclosure about the nature, amount, timing and uncertainty of revenue and cash flows arising from customer contracts, including significant judgments and changes in judgments and assets recognized from costs incurred to obtain or fulfill a contract.  This guidance is effective prospectively for the Company for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2016.  The Company is currently evaluating the effect the guidance will have on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
 
60

 

 
NOTE B:  ACQUISITIONS

On January 1, 2014, the Company, through its subsidiary, Harbridge Consulting Group, LLC (“Harbridge”), completed its acquisition of a professional services practice from EBS-RMSCO, Inc., a subsidiary of The Lifetime Healthcare Companies (“EBS-RMSCO”).  This professional services practice, which provides actuarial valuation and consulting services to clients who sponsor pension and post-retirement medical and welfare plans, enhances the Company’s participation in the Western New York market and added $1.2 million of incremental revenue in 2014.  The effects of the acquired assets and liabilities have been included in the consolidated financial statements since that date.

On December 13, 2013, the Bank completed its acquisition of eight branches in Northern Pennsylvania from Bank of America, N.A. (“B of A”), acquiring approximately $303 million of deposits and $1 million of loans.  The assumed deposits consist primarily of core deposits (checking, savings and money market accounts) and the purchased loans consist of in-market performing commercial loans. Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the Bank paid a blended deposit premium of 2.4%, or approximately $7.3 million.  The effects of the acquired assets and liabilities have been included in the consolidated financial statements since that date.  

On September 7, 2012, the Bank completed its acquisition of three branches in Western New York from First Niagara Bank, N.A. (“First Niagara”), acquiring approximately $54 million of loans and $101 million of deposits.  The assumed deposits consist primarily of core deposits (checking, savings and money market accounts) and the purchased loans consist of in-market performing loans, primarily residential real estate loans. Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the Bank paid a blended deposit premium of 3.1%, or approximately $3 million.  The effects of the acquired assets and liabilities have been included in the consolidated financial statements since that date.  

On July 20, 2012,  the Bank completed its acquisition of 16 retail branches in Central, Northern and Western New York from HSBC Bank USA, N.A. (“HSBC”), acquiring approximately $106 million in loans and $697 million of deposits.  The assumed deposits consist primarily of core deposits (checking, savings and money markets accounts) and the purchased loans consist of in-market performing loans, primarily residential real estate loans.  Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the Bank paid First Niagara (who acquired HSBC’s Upstate New York banking business and assigned its right to purchase the 16 branches to the Bank) a blended deposit premium of 3.4%, or approximately $24 million.  The effects of the acquired assets and liabilities have been included in the consolidated financial statements since that date.  

The assets and liabilities assumed in the acquisitions were recorded at their estimated fair values based on management's best estimates using information available at the dates of the acquisition, and are subject to adjustment based on updated information not available at the time of acquisition.  The following table summarizes the estimated fair value of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed.

(000s omitted)
2014
2013
2012
Consideration paid (received):
     
   Cash/Total net consideration paid (received)
$924  
($291,980)  
($595,462)  
Recognized amounts of identifiable assets
acquired and liabilities assumed:
     
   Cash and cash equivalents
0  
0  
5,510  
   Investment securities
0  
0  
0  
   Loans
0  
1,106  
160,116  
   Premises and equipment
0  
2,549  
4,941  
   Accrued interest receivable
0  
5  
588  
   Other assets/(liabilities), net
163  
(18)  
171  
   Core deposit intangibles
0  
2,537  
6,521  
   Other intangibles
578  
9  
0  
   Deposits
0  
(303,456)  
(797,962)  
     Total identifiable assets (liabilities), net
741  
(297,268)  
(620,115)  
        Goodwill
$183  
$5,288  
$24,653  

Acquired loans that have evidence of deterioration in credit quality since origination and for which it is probable, at acquisition, that the Company will be unable to collect all contractually required payments were aggregated by comparable characteristics and  recorded at fair value without a carryover of the related allowance for loan losses.  Cash flows for each loan were determined using an estimate of credit losses and an estimated rate of prepayments.  Projected monthly cash flows were then discounted to present value using a market-based discount rate.  The excess of the undiscounted expected cash flows over the estimated fair value is referred to as the “accretable yield” and is recognized into interest income over the remaining lives of the acquired loans.
 
 
61

 

 
The following is a summary of the loans acquired from HSBC and First Niagara at the date of acquisition:

 
(000’s omitted)
Acquired
Impaired
Loans
Acquired
Non-Impaired
Loans
Total
Acquired
 Loans
Contractually required principal and interest at acquisition
$0   
$201,745   
$201,745   
Contractual cash flows not expected to be collected
0   
(3,555)   
(3,555)   
    Expected cash flows at acquisition
0   
198,190   
198,190   
Interest component of expected cash flows
0   
(38,074)   
(38,074)   
   Fair value of acquired loans
$0   
$160,116   
$160,116   

The fair value of checking, savings and money market deposit accounts acquired were assumed to approximate the carrying value as these accounts have no stated maturity and are payable on demand.  Certificate of deposit accounts were valued as the present value of the certificates’ expected contractual payments discounted at market rates for similar certificates, which approximated their book values.

The core deposit intangibles and other intangibles related to the B of A, HSBC, and CAI acquisitions are being amortized using an accelerated method over their estimated useful life of approximately eight to ten years.  The goodwill, which is not amortized for book purposes, was assigned to the Banking segment for the B of A, First Niagara, and HSBC acquisitions and to the Employee Benefit Services segment for the CAI acquisition.  The goodwill arising from the CAI, B of A branch, HSBC branch and First Niagara branch acquisitions is deductible for tax purposes.

Direct costs related to the acquisitions were expensed as incurred.  Merger and acquisition integration-related expenses amount to $0.1 million, $2.2 million and $5.7 million during 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, and have been separately stated in the Consolidated Statements of Income.

Supplemental pro forma financial information related to the B of A, HSBC and First Niagara acquisitions has not been provided as it would be impracticable to do so.  Historical financial information regarding the acquired branches is not accessible and thus the amounts would require estimates so significant as to render the disclosure irrelevant.

NOTE C:  INVESTMENT SECURITIES

The amortized cost and estimated fair value of investment securities as of December 31 are as follows:

 
2014
 
2013
   
Gross
Gross
Estimated
   
Gross
Gross
Estimated
 
Amortized
Unrealized
Unrealized
Fair
 
Amortized
Unrealized
Unrealized
Fair
(000's omitted)
Cost
Gains
Losses
Value
 
Cost
Gains
Losses
Value
Available-for-Sale Portfolio:
                 
U.S. Treasury and agency securities
$1,479,134
$39,509
$910
$1,517,733
 
$1,252,332
$1,119
$41,304
$1,212,147
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
645,398
26,749
244
671,903
 
665,441
15,919
12,378
668,982
Government agency mortgage-backed securities
228,971
9,782
1,025
237,728
 
250,431
8,660
4,113
254,978
Corporate debt securities
26,803
363
75
27,091
 
26,932
873
218
27,587
Government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
17,330
695
0
18,025
 
21,779
362
93
22,048
Marketable equity securities
250
195
0
445
 
250
171
0
421
Total available-for-sale portfolio
$2,397,886
$77,293
$2,254
$2,472,925
 
$2,217,165
$27,104
$58,106
$2,186,163
                   
Other Securities:
                 
Federal Home Loan Bank common stock
$19,553
   
$19,553
 
$12,053
   
$12,053
Federal Reserve Bank common stock
16,050
   
16,050
 
16,050
   
16,050
Other equity securities
4,446
   
4,446
 
4,459
   
4,459
Total other securities
$40,049
   
$40,049
 
$32,562
   
$32,562

The Company undertook a balance sheet restructuring program during the first half of 2013 through the sale of certain longer duration investment securities and retirement of the Company’s existing FHLB term borrowings.  During the first half of 2013, the Company sold $648.7 million of U.S. Treasury and agency securities classified as available-for-sale, realizing $63.8 million of gains.  The proceeds from those sales were utilized to retire FHLB term borrowings.
 
 
 
62

 

In December 2013, in response to the issuance of the “Volcker Rule”, the Company sold its entire portfolio of pooled trust preferred securities, realizing a loss of $15.5 million, as well as U.S. Treasury securities with a book value of $417.6 million that were previously classified as held-to-maturity, realizing $32.4 million of gains.  The proceeds from these sales were utilized to retire the remaining FHLB term borrowings.  As a result of the securities sold from the held-to-maturity classification, the remaining unsold securities within the held-to-maturity classification, with a book value of $198.9 million, were transferred to the available-for-sale classification prior to December 31, 2013. An unrealized loss of $1.8 million was recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income.  In addition, as a result of the sale of securities classified as held-to-maturity, the Company did not use the held-to-maturity classification in 2014.

A summary of investment securities that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for less than or greater than twelve months is as follows:

As of December 31, 2014
 
   
Less than 12 Months
     12 Months or Longer    Total
       
Gross
     
Gross
     
Gross
     
Fair
Unrealized
   
Fair
Unrealized
   
Fair
Unrealized
(000's omitted)
 
  #
Value
Losses
 
#
Value
Losses
 
#
Value
Losses
                         
Available-for-Sale Portfolio:
                       
 U.S. Treasury and agency obligations
 
0
$0
$0
 
4
$102,363
$910
 
4
$102,363
$910
 Obligations of state and political subdivisions
 
23
13,413
34
 
46
26,490
210
 
69
39,903
244
 Government agency mortgage-backed securities
 
3
5
0
 
19
34,770
1,025
 
22
34,775
1,025
 Corporate debt securities
 
1
3,040
1
 
1
2,755
74
 
2
5,795
75
 Government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
 
1
0
0
 
1
5
0
 
2
5
0
    Total available-for-sale/investment portfolio
 
28
$16,458
$35
 
71
$166,383
$2,219
 
99
$182,841
$2,254
 
As of December 31, 2013
 
      Less than 12 Months    12 Months or Longer    Total
       
Gross
     
Gross
     
Gross
     
Fair
Unrealized
   
Fair
Unrealized
   
Fair
Unrealized
(000's omitted)
 
  #
Value
Losses
 
#   
Value
Losses
 
  #
Value
Losses
                         
Available-for-Sale Portfolio:
                       
 U.S. Treasury and agency obligations
 
43
$1,181,214
$41,304
 
0
$0
$0
 
43
$1,181,214
$41,304
 Obligations of state and political subdivisions
 
302
195,526
11,774
 
9
4,974
604
 
311
200,500
12,378
 Government agency mortgage-backed securities
 
43
68,917
3,262
 
6
8,713
851
 
49
77,630
4,113
 Corporate debt securities
 
1
3,026
31
 
1
2,703
187
 
2
5,729
218
 Government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
 
1
2,601
93
 
1
7
0
 
2
2,608
93
    Total available-for-sale/investment portfolio
 
390
$1,451,284
$56,464
 
17
$16,397
$1,642
 
407
$1,467,681
$58,106

The unrealized losses reported pertaining to securities issued by the U.S. government and its sponsored entities, include treasuries, agencies, and mortgage-backed securities issued by GNMA, FNMA and FHLMC which are currently rated AAA by Moody’s Investor Services, AA+ by Standard & Poor’s and are guaranteed by the U.S. government. The majority of the obligations of state and political subdivisions and corporations carry a credit rating of A or better.  Additionally, a majority of the obligations of state and political subdivisions carry a secondary level of credit enhancement. The Company does not intend to sell these securities, nor is it more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell these securities prior to recovery of the amortized cost. The unrealized losses in the portfolios are primarily attributable to changes in interest rates.  As such, management does not believe any individual unrealized loss as of December 31, 2014 represents OTTI.
 
 
63

 

The amortized cost and estimated fair value of debt securities at December 31, 2014, by contractual maturity, are shown below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.  Securities not due at a single maturity date are shown separately.

   
Available-for-Sale
   
Amortized
Fair
(000's omitted)
 
Cost
Value
Due in one year or less
 
$59,386
$60,045
Due after one through five years
 
146,559
150,631
Due after five years through ten years
 
1,698,124
1,746,688
Due after ten years
 
247,266
259,363
     Subtotal
 
2,151,335
2,216,727
Government agency mortgage-backed securities
 
228,971
237,728
Government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
 
17,330
18,025
     Total
 
$2,397,636
$2,472,480

Cash flow information on investment securities for the years ended December 31 is as follows:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
2012
Gross gains on sales of investment securities
$0
$96,258
$350
Gross losses on sales of investment securities
0
15,490
59
Proceeds from the maturities of mortgage-backed securities and CMO's
46,791
83,232
109,843
Purchases of mortgage-backed securities and CMO's
22,234
51,194
26,292

Investment securities with a carrying value of $1.182 billion and $0.978 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, were pledged to collateralize certain deposits and borrowings.

NOTE D:  LOANS

The segments of the Company’s loan portfolio are disaggregated into the following classes that allow management to monitor risk and performance:
 
●  
Consumer mortgages consist primarily of fixed rate residential instruments, typically 10 – 30 years in contractual term, secured by first liens on real property.
●  
Business lending is comprised of general purpose commercial and industrial loans including, but not limited to agricultural-related and dealer floor plans, as well as mortgages on commercial property.
●  
Consumer indirect consists primarily of installment loans originated through selected dealerships and are secured by automobiles, marine and other recreational vehicles.
●  
Consumer direct consists of all other loans to consumers such as personal installment loans and lines of credit.
●  
Home equity products are consumer purpose installment loans or lines of credit most often secured by a first or second lien position on residential real estate with terms up to 30 years.

The balances of these classes at December 31 are summarized as follows:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
Consumer mortgage
$1,613,384
$1,582,058
Business lending
1,262,484
1,260,364
Consumer indirect
833,968
740,002
Consumer direct
184,028
180,139
Home equity
342,342
346,520
Gross loans, including deferred origination costs
4,236,206
4,109,083
Allowance for loan losses
(45,341)
(44,319)
Loans, net of allowance for loan losses
$4,190,865
$4,064,764

The Company had approximately $18.7 million and $18.5 million of net deferred loan origination costs included in gross loans as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
 
 
64

 

Certain directors and executive officers of the Company, as well as associates of such persons, are loan customers.  Loans to these individuals were made in the ordinary course of business under normal credit terms and do not have more than a normal risk of collection.  Following is a summary of the aggregate amount of such loans during 2014 and 2013.

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
Balance at beginning of year
$9,448
$8,292
New loans
1,647
3,643
Payments
(2,167)
(2,487)
Balance at end of year
$8,928
$9,448
 
Acquired loans
 
Acquired loans are recorded at fair value as of the date of purchase with no allowance for loan loss.  The outstanding principal balance and the related carrying amount of acquired loans included in the Consolidated Statement of Condition at December 31 are as follows:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
Credit impaired acquired loans:
   
   Outstanding principal balance
$5,957
$11,457
   Carrying amount
5,312
7,090
     
Non-impaired acquired loans:
   
   Outstanding principal balance
276,584
342,542
   Carrying amount
267,496
330,118
     
Total acquired loans:
   
   Outstanding principal balance
282,541
353,999
   Carrying amount
272,808
337,208

The outstanding balance related to credit impaired acquired loans was $6.1 million and $13.1 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.  The changes in the accretable discount related to the credit impaired acquired loans are as follows:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
Balance at beginning of year
$997 
$ 1,770 
Accretion recognized
(707) 
(1,025) 
Net reclassification to accretable from nonaccretable
415 
252 
Balance at end of year
$705 
$997 

Credit Quality
Management monitors the credit quality of its loan portfolio on an ongoing basis.  Measurement of delinquency and past due status are based on the contractual terms of each loan.  Past due loans are reviewed on a monthly basis to identify loans for non-accrual status.  The following is an aged analysis of the Company’s past due loans by class as of December 31, 2014:

Legacy Loans (excludes loans acquired after January 1, 2009)

(000’s omitted)
Past Due
30 - 89
days
90+ Days Past
Due and
 Still Accruing
Nonaccrual
Total
Past Due
Current
Total Loans
Consumer mortgage
$13,978
$2,165
$13,201
$29,344
$1,515,057
$1,544,401
Business lending
6,738
350
2,291
9,379
1,115,215
1,124,594
Consumer indirect
10,529
82
10
10,621
822,124
832,745
Consumer direct
1,389
36
2
1,427
177,158
178,585
Home equity
1,802
195
2,172
4,169
278,904
283,073
Total
$34,436
$2,828
$17,676
$54,940
$3,908,458
$3,963,398
 
 
65

 
 

Acquired Loans (includes loans acquired after January 1, 2009)

 
(000’s omitted)
Past Due
30 - 89
days
90+ Days Past
Due and
 Still Accruing
Nonaccrual
Total
Past Due
 
Acquired
Impaired(1)
Current
Total Loans
Consumer mortgage
$1,892
$232
$2,122
$4,246
$0
$64,737
$68,983
Business lending
608
0
489
1,097
5,312
131,481
137,890
Consumer indirect
40
0
0
40
0
1,183
1,223
Consumer direct
174
0
18
192
0
5,251
5,443
Home equity
674
46
426
1,146
0
58,123
59,269
Total
$3,388
$278
$3,055
$6,721
$5,312
$260,775
$272,808

(1)  
Acquired impaired loans were not classified as nonperforming assets as the loans are considered to be
performing under ASC 310-30.  As a result interest income, through the accretion of the difference
between the carrying amount of the loans and the expected cashflows, is being recognized on all acquired
impaired loans.

The following is an aged analysis of the Company’s past due loans by class as of December 31, 2013:

Legacy Loans (excludes loans acquired after January 1, 2009)

(000’s omitted)
Past Due
30 - 89
days
90+ Days Past
Due and
 Still Accruing
Nonaccrual
Total
Past Due
Current
Total Loans
Consumer mortgage
$16,589
$1,253
$11,097
 $28,939
$1,473,320
 $1,502,259
Business lending
2,960
164
3,083
6,207
1,079,818
1,086,025
Consumer indirect
11,647
738
14
12,399
723,878
736,277
Consumer direct
1,858
90
4
1,952
169,452
171,404
Home equity
2,635
173
1,867
4,675
271,235
275,910
Total
$35,689
$2,418
$16,065
 $54,172
$3,717,703
 $3,771,875

Acquired Loans (includes loans acquired after January 1, 2009)

 
(000’s omitted)
Past Due
30 - 89
days
90+ Days Past Due and
 Still Accruing
Nonaccrual
Total
Past Due
 
Acquired Impaired(1)
Current
Total Loans
Consumer mortgage
$1,857
$85
$1,463
$3,405
$0
$76,394
$79,799
Business lending
531
0
1,472
2,003
7,090
165,246
174,339
Consumer indirect
157
17
0
174
0
3,551
3,725
Consumer direct
385
27
0
412
0
8,323
8,735
Home equity
592
8
473
1,073
0
69,537
70,610
Total
$3,522
$137
$3,408
$7,067
$7,090
$323,051
$337,208

(1)  
Acquired impaired loans were not classified as nonperforming assets as the loans are considered to be
performing under ASC 310-30.  As a result interest income, through the accretion of the difference
between the carrying amount of the loans and the expected cashflows, is being recognized on all acquired
impaired loans.

The Company uses several credit quality indicators to assess credit risk in an ongoing manner.  The Company’s primary credit quality indicator for its business lending portfolio is an internal credit risk rating system that categorizes loans as “pass”, “special mention”, or “classified”.  Credit risk ratings are applied individually to those classes of loans that have significant or unique credit characteristics that benefit from a case-by-case evaluation.  In general, the following are the definitions of the Company’s credit quality indicators:
 
Pass The condition of the borrower and the performance of the loans are satisfactory or better.
   
Special Mention The condition of the borrower has deteriorated although the loan performs as agreed.
   
Classified The condition of the borrower has significantly deteriorated and the performance of the loan could further deteriorate if deficiencies are not corrected.
   
Doubtful The condition of the borrower has deteriorated to the point that collection of the balance is improbable based on current facts and conditions.
 
 
66

 
 
The following table shows the amount of business lending loans by credit quality category:

 
December 31, 2014
 
December 31, 2013
(000’s omitted)
Legacy
Acquired
Total
 
Legacy
Acquired
Total
Pass
$949,960
$93,510
$1,043,470
 
$908,885
$116,271
$1,025,156
Special mention
103,176
18,038
121,214
 
93,600
24,264
117,864
Classified
71,458
21,030
92,488
 
83,379
26,714
110,093
Doubtful
0
0
0
 
161
0
161
Acquired impaired
0
5,312
5,312
 
0
7,090
7,090
Total
$1,124,594
$137,890
$1,262,484
 
$1,086,025
$174,339
$1,260,364

All other loans are underwritten and structured using standardized criteria and characteristics, primarily payment performance, and are normally risk rated and monitored collectively on a monthly basis.  These are typically loans to individuals in the consumer categories and are delineated as either performing or nonperforming.  Performing loans include current, 30 – 89 days past due and acquired impaired loans.  Nonperforming loans include 90+ days past due and still accruing and nonaccrual loans.  The following tables detail the balances in all loan categories except for business lending at December 31, 2014:
 
Legacy loans (excludes loans acquired after January 1, 2009)
 
(000’s omitted)
Consumer
Mortgage
Consumer
Indirect
Consumer
Direct
Home
Equity
Total
Performing
$1,529,035
$832,653
$178,547
$280,706
$2,820,941
Nonperforming
15,366
92
38
2,367
17,863
Total
$1,544,401
$832,745
$178,585
$283,073
$2,838,804

Acquired loans (includes loans acquired after January 1, 2009)
 
(000’s omitted)
Consumer
Mortgage
Consumer
Indirect
Consumer
Direct
Home
Equity
Total
Performing
$66,629
$1,223
$5,425
$58,797
$132,074
Nonperforming
2,354
0
18
472
2,844
Total
$68,983
$1,223
$5,443
$59,269
$134,918

The following table details the balances in all other loan categories at December 31, 2013:

Legacy loans (excludes loans acquired after January 1, 2009)
 
(000’s omitted)
Consumer
Mortgage
Consumer
Indirect
Consumer
Direct
Home
Equity
Total
Performing
$1,489,909
$735,525
$171,310
$273,870
$2,670,614
Nonperforming
12,350
752
94
2,040
15,236
Total
$1,502,259
$736,277
$171,404
$275,910
$2,685,850

Acquired loans (includes loans acquired after January 1, 2009)
 
(000’s omitted)
Consumer
Mortgage
Consumer
Indirect
Consumer
Direct
Home
Equity
Total
Performing
$78,251
$3,708
$8,708
$70,129
$160,796
Nonperforming
1,548
17
27
481
2,073
Total
$79,799
$3,725
$8,735
$70,610
$162,869

All loan classes are collectively evaluated for impairment except business lending, as described in Note A.  A summary of individually evaluated impaired loans as of December 31, 2014 and 2013 is as follows:

(000’s omitted)
2014
2013
Loans with allowance allocation
$0  
$945  
Loans without allowance allocation
0  
600  
Carrying balance
0  
1,545  
Contractual balance
0  
1,852  
Specifically allocated allowance
0  
50  
Average impaired loans
0  
10,729  
Interest income recognized
0  
18  
 
 
67

 

In the course of working with borrowers, the Company may choose to restructure the contractual terms of certain loans.  In this scenario, the Company attempts to work-out an alternative payment schedule with the borrower in order to optimize collectability of the loan.  Any loans that are modified are reviewed by the Company to identify if a troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”) has occurred, which is when, for economic or legal reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties, the Company grants a concession to the borrower that it would not otherwise consider.  Terms may be modified to fit the ability of the borrower to repay in line with its current financial standing and the restructuring of the loan may include the transfer of assets from the borrower to satisfy the debt, a modification of loan terms, or a combination of the two.  With regard to determination of the amount of the allowance for loan losses, troubled debt restructured loans are considered to be impaired.  As a result, the determination of the amount of allowance for loan losses related to impaired loans for each portfolio segment within TDRs is the same as detailed previously.
 
In accordance with clarified guidance issued by the OCC in 2012, loans that have been discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy but not reaffirmed by the borrower, are classified as TDRs, irrespective of payment history or delinquency status, even if the repayment terms for the loan have not been otherwise modified.  The Company’s lien position against the underlying collateral remains unchanged.  Pursuant to that guidance, the Company records a charge-off equal to any portion of the carrying value that exceeds the net realizable value of the collateral.  The amount of loss incurred in 2012, 2013 and 2014 was immaterial.

TDRs less than $0.5 million are collectively included in the general loan loss allocation and the qualitative review, if necessary.  Commercial loans greater than $0.5 million are individually evaluated for impairment, and if necessary, a specific allocation of the allowance for loan losses is provided.

Information regarding TDRs as of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 is as follows
 
 
December 31, 2014
 
December 31, 2013
(000’s omitted)
Nonaccrual
Accruing
Total
 
Nonaccrual
Accruing
Total
 
#
Amount
#
Amount
#
Amount
 
#
Amount
#
Amount
#
Amount
Consumer mortgage
49 
$2,092
37
$1,770
86
$3,862 
 
31 
$1,682
48
$2,171
79
$3,853
Business lending
442
3
468
9
910 
 
162
1
47
5
209
Consumer indirect
0
79
615
79
615 
 
0
98
692
98
692
Consumer direct
0
25
69
25
69 
 
0
46
116
46
116
Home equity
13 
218
13
278
26
496 
 
12 
202
20
363
32
565
Total
68 
$2,752
157
$3,200
225
$5,952 
 
47 
$2,046
213
$3,389
260
$5,435

The following table presents information related to loans modified in a TDR during the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.  Of the loans noted in the table below, all but three loans for the year ended December 31, 2014 and all but two loans for the year ended December 31, 2013, were modified due to a Chapter 7 bankruptcy as described previously.  Of the three non-Chapter 7 bankruptcy TDRs in 2014 two relate to business loans restructured via granting a waiver of payments for a period of time and one was a business loan that was restructured via an extension of term.  The 2013 non-Chapter 7 bankruptcy TDRs relate to a business loan restructured via an extension of term and a consumer mortgage restructured via an extension of term and a rate concession.  The financial effects of these restructurings were immaterial.

 
December 31, 2014
 
December 31, 2013
(000’s omitted)
#
Amount
 
#
Amount
Consumer mortgage
22
$949
 
31
$1,758
Business lending
7
769
 
3
183
Consumer indirect
33
312
 
36
327
Consumer direct
14
26
 
22
75
Home equity
6
145
 
14
298
Total
82
$2,201
 
106
$2,641
 
 
68

 

Allowance for Loan Losses

The allowance for loan losses is general in nature and is available to absorb losses from any loan type despite the analysis below.  The following presents by class the activity in the allowance for loan losses:

 
Consumer
Business
Home
Consumer
Consumer
 
Acquired
 
(000’s omitted)
Mortgage
Lending
Equity
Indirect
Direct
Unallocated
Impaired
Total
Balance at
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   December 31, 2012
$7,070
$18,013
$1,451
$9,606
$3,303
$2,666
$779
$42,888
Charge-offs
(1,012)
(2,788)
(650)
(4,544)
(1,954)
0
(883)
(11,831)
Recoveries
36
692
20
3,488
1,034
0
0
5,270
Provision
2,900
1,590
1,009
1,698
798
(637)
634
7,992
Balance at
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    December 31, 2013 8,994    17,507   1,830   10,248   3,181   2,029   530   44,319  
Charge-offs
(1,075)
(1,558)
(765)
(6,784)
(1,595)
0
(38)
(11,815)
Recoveries
205
750
85
3,773
846
0
0
5,659
Provision
2,162
(912)
1,551
4,307
651
(262)
(319)
7,178
Balance at
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    December 31, 2014 $10,286   $15,787   $2,701   $11,544   $3,083   $1,767   $173   $45,341  

NOTE E:  PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT

Premises and equipment consist of the following at December 31:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
Land and land improvements
$17,722
$15,714
Bank premises
96,754
95,275
Equipment and construction in progress
78,679
75,523
  Premises and equipment, gross
193,155
186,512
Accumulated depreciation
(99,522)
(92,876)
  Premises and equipment, net
$93,633
$93,636

NOTE F:  GOODWILL AND IDENTIFIABLE INTANGIBLE ASSETS

The gross carrying amount and accumulated amortization for each type of identifiable intangible asset are as follows:

   
December 31, 2014
 
December 31, 2013
   
Gross
 
Net
 
Gross
 
Net
   
Carrying
Accumulated
Carrying
 
Carrying
Accumulated
Carrying
(000's omitted)
 
Amount
Amortization
Amount
 
Amount
Amortization
Amount
Amortizing intangible assets:
               
  Core deposit intangibles
 
$40,326
($30,303)
$10,023
 
$40,326
($26,866)
$13,460
  Other intangibles
 
10,019
(8,243)
1,776
 
9,441
(7,393)
2,048
 Total amortizing intangibles
 
$50,345
($38,546)
$11,799
 
$49,767
($34,259)
$15,508

The estimated aggregate amortization expense for each of the five succeeding fiscal years ended December 31 is as follows:

2015
$3,408
2016
2,612
2017
1,908
2018
1,424
2019
1,002
Thereafter
1,445
Total
$11,799
 
 
69

 

Shown below are the components of the Company’s goodwill at December 31, 2014 and 2013:

 
Year Ended
 
Year Ended
 
Year Ended
(000’s omitted)
December 31, 2012
Activity
December 31, 2013
Activity
December 31, 2014
Goodwill
$374,527
$5,288
$379,815
$183 
$379,998
Accumulated impairment
(4,824)
0
(4,824)
(4,824)
Goodwill, net
$369,703
$5,288
$374,991
$183 
$375,174

During the first quarter, the Company performed its annual internal valuation of goodwill and impairment analysis by comparing the fair value of each reporting unit to its carrying value.  Results of the valuations indicate there was no goodwill impairment.

Mortgage Servicing Rights
Under certain circumstances, the Company sells consumer residential mortgage loans in the secondary market and typically retains the right to service the loans sold.  Generally, the Company’s residential mortgage loans sold to third parties are sold on a non-recourse basis.  Upon sale, a mortgage servicing right (“MSR”) is established, which represents the then current fair value of future net cash flows expected to be realized for performing the servicing activities.  The Company stratifies these assets based on predominant risk characteristics, namely expected term of the underlying financial instruments, and uses a valuation model that calculates the present value of future cash flows to determine the fair value of servicing rights. MSRs are recorded in other assets at the lower of the initial capitalized amount, net of accumulated amortization or fair value.  Mortgage loans serviced for others are not included in the accompanying consolidated statements of condition.

The following table summarizes the changes in carrying value of MSRs and the associated valuation allowance:

(000’s omitted)
2014
2013
Carrying value before valuation allowance at beginning of period
$1,218 
$1,458 
Additions
315 
289 
Amortization
(444) 
(529) 
Carrying value before valuation allowance at end of period
1,089 
1,218 
Valuation allowance balance at beginning of period
(430) 
Impairment charges
(111) 
Impairment recoveries
541 
Valuation allowance balance at end of period
Net carrying value at end of period
$1,089 
$1,218 
Fair value of MSRs at end of period
$1,616 
$1,495 
Principal balance of loans sold during the year
$25,728 
$25,179 
Principal balance of loans serviced for others
$302,895 
$322,030 
Custodial escrow balances maintained in connection with loans serviced for others
$4,320 
$4,519 

The following table summarizes the key economic assumptions used to estimate the value of the MSRs at December 31:

 
2014
2013
Weighted-average contractual life (in years)
19.6 
19.2 
Weighted-average constant prepayment rate (CPR)
12.8% 
18.0% 
Weighted-average discount rate
3.2% 
4.5% 

NOTE G:  DEPOSITS

Deposits consist of the following at December 31:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
Noninterest checking
$1,324,661
$1,203,346
Interest checking
1,348,995
1,289,676
Savings
1,032,617
1,010,196
Money market
1,455,991
1,466,273
Time
773,000
926,553
  Total deposits
$5,935,264
$5,896,044

At December 31, 2014 and 2013, time deposits in denominations of $100,000 and greater totaled $169.9 million and $206.4 million, respectively.  The approximate maturities of these time deposits at December 31, 2014 are as follows:
 
 
70

 
 

(000's omitted)
Amount
2015
$104,004
2016
30,032
2017
18,052
2018
9,387
2019
6,599
Thereafter
1,813
  Total
$169,887
 
NOTE H:  BORROWINGS

Outstanding borrowings at December 31 are as follows:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
  FHLB overnight advance
$338,000
$141,900
  Capital lease obligations
0
13
  Subordinated debt held by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts,
   
    net of discount of $405 and $430, respectively
102,122
102,097
        Total borrowings
$440,122
$244,010

FHLB advances are collateralized by a blanket lien on the Company's residential real estate loan portfolio and various investment securities.

The Company undertook a balance sheet restructuring program during the first half of 2013 through the sale of certain longer duration investment securities and retirement of the Company’s existing FHLB term advances.  During the first half of 2013, the Company sold securities and utilized the proceeds to retire $501.6 million of FHLB term borrowings with $63.5 million of associated early extinguishments costs.

During December 2013, in response to the issuance of the “Volcker Rule”, the Company sold certain investment securities and utilized the proceeds to retire the remaining $226.4 million FHLB term advances with $23.8 million of associated early extinguishment costs.

Borrowings at December 31, 2014 have contractual maturity dates as follows:

(000's omitted, except rate)
 Carrying Value
Weighted-average Rate at
December 31, 2014
January 2, 2015
$338,000
0.32%
July 31, 2031
24,802
3.81%
December 15, 2036
77,320
1.89%
   Total
$440,122
0.79%

The weighted-average interest rate on borrowings for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 was 0.89% and 2.70%, respectively.

The Company sponsors two business trusts, Community Statutory Trust III and Community Capital Trust IV, of which 100% of the common stock is owned by the Company.  The trusts were formed for the purpose of issuing company-obligated mandatorily redeemable preferred securities to third-party investors and investing the proceeds from the sale of such preferred securities solely in junior subordinated debt securities of the Company.  The debentures held by each trust are the sole assets of that trust.  Distributions on the preferred securities issued by each trust are payable quarterly at a rate per annum equal to the interest rate being earned by the trust on the debentures held by that trust and are recorded as interest expense in the consolidated financial statements.  The preferred securities are subject to mandatory redemption, in whole or in part, upon repayment of the debentures.  The Company has entered into agreements which, taken collectively, fully and unconditionally guarantee the preferred securities subject to the terms of each of the guarantees.  The terms of the preferred securities of each trust are as follows:

 
Issuance
Par
Interest
Maturity
Call
Trust
Date
Amount
Rate
Date
Price
III
7/31/2001
$24.5 million
3 month LIBOR plus 3.58% (3.81%)
7/31/2031
Par
IV
12/8/2006
$75 million
3 month LIBOR plus 1.65% (1.89%)
12/15/2036
  Par


 
71

 


NOTE I:  INCOME TAXES

The provision for income taxes for the years ended December 31 is as follows:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
2012
Current:
     
     Federal
$30,006
$24,202
$18,875
     State and other
870
866
830
Deferred:
     
     Federal
6,867
5,806
9,051
     State and other
594
1,324
2,981
Provision for income taxes
$38,337
$32,198
$31,737

Components of the net deferred tax liability, included in other liabilities, as of December 31 are as follows:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
Allowance for loan losses
$17,476
$17,246
Employee benefits
6,834
6,329
Investment securities
0
4,882
Debt extinguishment
904
1,215
Other, net
10,725
11,701
  Deferred tax asset
35,939
41,373
     
Investment securities
37,527
0
Tax-deductible goodwill
35,842
31,997
Loan origination costs
6,792
6,883
Depreciation
3,722
4,838
Mortgage servicing rights
419
473
Pension
16,845
21,735
  Deferred tax liability
101,147
65,926
Net deferred tax liability
($65,208)
($24,553)

The Company has determined that no valuation allowance is necessary as it is more likely than not that the gross deferred tax assets will be realized through carryback of future deductions to taxable income in prior years, future reversals of existing temporary differences, and through future taxable income.

A reconciliation of the differences between the federal statutory income tax rate and the effective tax rate for the years ended December 31 is shown in the following table:
 
 
2014
2013
2012
Federal statutory income tax rate
35.0%
35.0%
35.0%
Increase (reduction) in taxes resulting from:
     
     Tax-exempt interest
(5.4)
(6.3)
(7.1)
     State income taxes, net of federal benefit
0.7
1.3
2.3
     Other
(0.7)
(1.0)
(1.0)
Effective income tax rate
29.6%
29.0%
29.2%

A reconciliation of the unrecognized tax benefits for the years ended December 31 is shown in the following table:
 
(000’s omitted)
2014
2013
2012
Unrecognized tax benefits at beginning of year
$138
$70
$133
Changes related to:
     
     Positions taken during the current year
24
68
35
     Settlements with taxing authorities
0
0
(98)
Unrecognized tax benefits at end of year
$162
$138
$70

As of December 31, 2014, the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits that would impact the Company’s effective tax rate if recognized is $0.2 million.  It is reasonably possible that the amount of unrecognized tax benefits could change in the next twelve months as a result of various examinations and expiration of statutes of limitations on prior tax returns.
 
 
 
72

 
 
The Company’s policy is to recognize interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits as part of income taxes in the consolidated statement of income.  The accrued interest related to tax positions was immaterial.

The Company’s federal and state income tax returns are routinely subject to examination from various governmental taxing authorities.  Such examinations may result in challenges to the tax return treatment applied by the Company to specific transactions.  Management believes that the assumptions and judgment used to record tax-related assets or liabilities have been appropriate.  Future examinations by taxing authorities of the Company’s federal or state tax returns could have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations.  The Company’s federal income tax returns for years after 2010 may still be examined by the Internal Revenue Service.  New York State income tax returns for years after 2010 may still be examined by the New York Department of Taxation and Finance.  It is not possible to estimate when those examinations may be completed.

NOTE J:  LIMITS ON DIVIDENDS AND OTHER REVENUE SOURCES

The Company’s ability to pay dividends to its shareholders is largely dependent on the Bank’s ability to pay dividends to the Company.  In addition to state law requirements and the capital requirements discussed below, the circumstances under which the Bank may pay dividends are limited by federal statutes, regulations, and policies.  For example, as a national bank, the Bank must obtain the approval of the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) for payments of dividends if the total of all dividends declared in any calendar year would exceed the total of the Bank’s net profits, as defined by applicable regulations, for that year, combined with its retained net profits for the preceding two years.  Furthermore, the Bank may not pay a dividend in an amount greater than its undivided profits then on hand after deducting its losses and bad debts, as defined by applicable regulations.  At December 31, 2014, the Bank had approximately $121 million in undivided profits legally available for the payment of dividends.

In addition, the Federal Reserve Board and the OCC are authorized to determine under certain circumstances that the payment of dividends would be an unsafe or unsound practice and to prohibit payment of such dividends.  The Federal Reserve Board has indicated that banking organizations should generally pay dividends only out of current operating earnings.

There are also statutory limits on the transfer of funds to the Company by its banking subsidiary, whether in the form of loans or other extensions of credit, investments or assets purchases.  Such transfer by the Bank to the Company generally is limited in amount to 10% of the Bank’s capital and surplus, or 20% in the aggregate.  Furthermore, such loans and extensions of credit are required to be collateralized in specific amounts.


 
73

 


NOTE K:  BENEFIT PLANS

Pension and post-retirement plans
The Company provides a qualified defined benefit pension to eligible employees and retirees, other post-retirement health and life insurance benefits to certain retirees, an unfunded supplemental pension plan for certain key executives, and an unfunded stock balance plan for certain of its nonemployee directors.  Using a measurement date of December 31, the following table shows the funded status of the Company's plans reconciled with amounts reported in the Company's consolidated statements of condition:

   
Pension Benefits
 
Post-retirement Benefits
(000's omitted)
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Change in benefit obligation:
           
  Benefit obligation at the beginning of year
 
$111,174
$123,739
 
$2,340
$3,051
  Service cost
 
3,530
3,988
 
0
0
  Interest cost
 
5,271
4,120
 
102
88
  Plan amendment
 
2,091
0
 
0
0
  Participant contributions
 
0
0
 
551
608
  Deferred actuarial loss (gain)
 
13,005
(14,610)
 
55
(301)
  Benefits paid
 
(7,558)
(6,063)
 
(792)
(1,106)
Benefit obligation at end of year
 
127,513
111,174
 
2,256
2,340
Change in plan assets:
           
  Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year
 
173,416
143,661
 
0
0
  Actual return of plan assets
 
11,391
25,196
 
0
0
  Participant contributions
 
0
0
 
551
608
  Employer contributions
 
616
10,622
 
241
498
  Benefits paid
 
(7,558)
(6,063)
 
(792)
(1,106)
Fair value of plan assets at end of year
 
177,865
173,416
 
0
0
Over/(Under) funded status at year end
 
$50,352
$62,242
 
($2,256)
($2,340)
             
Amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheet were:
   Other assets
 
$61,437
$73,790
 
$0
$0
   Other liabilities
 
(11,085)
(11,548)
 
(2,256)
(2,340)
             
Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) (“AOCI”) were:
   Net loss (gain)
 
$26,748
$12,905
 
$36
($25)
   Net prior service cost (credit)
 
2,316
797
 
(2,159)
(2,338)
   Pre-tax AOCI
 
29,064
13,702
 
(2,123)
(2,363)
   Taxes
 
(11,033)
(5,095)
 
808
901
    AOCI at year end
 
$18,031
$8,607
 
($1,315)
($1,462)

The benefit obligation for the defined benefit pension plan was $116.4 million and $99.6 million as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and the fair value of plan assets as of December 31, 2014 and 2013 was $177.9 million and $173.4 million, respectively.  The defined benefit pension plan was amended effective December 31, 2014 to transfer certain obligations from the Company’s non-qualified supplemental pension plan and deferred compensation plan into the qualified defined benefit pension plan.

The Company has unfunded supplemental pension plans for certain key active and retired executives.  The projected benefit obligation for the unfunded supplemental pension plan for certain key executives was $11.0 million for 2014 and $11.4 million for 2013, respectively.  The Company also has an unfunded stock balance plan for certain of its nonemployee directors.  The projected benefit obligation for the unfunded stock balance plan was $0.1 million for 2014 and $0.1 million for 2013, respectively.  The plan was frozen effective December 31, 2009.

Effective December 31, 2009, the Company terminated its post-retirement medical program for current and future employees.  Remaining plan participants will include only existing retirees as of December 31, 2010.  This change was accounted for as a negative plan amendment and a $3.5 million, net of income taxes, benefit for prior service was recognized in AOCI in 2009.  This negative plan amendment is being amortized over the expected benefit utilization period of remaining plan participants.


 
74

 


Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income, net of tax, for the year ended December 31, are as follows:

   
Pension Benefits
 
Post-retirement Benefits
(000's omitted)
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Prior service cost
 
$932
($46)
 
$109
$109
Net (gain) loss
 
8,492
(20,513)
 
38
(190)
     Total
 
$9,424
($20,559)
 
$147
($81)

The estimated costs, net of tax, that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive (income) loss into net periodic (income) cost over the next fiscal year are as follows:

   
Pension
Post-retirement
(000's omitted)
 
Benefits
Benefits
Prior service credit
 
$9
($179)
Net loss
 
1,447
5
     Total
 
$1,456
($174)

The weighted-average assumptions used to determine the benefit obligations as of December 31 are as follows:

   
Pension Benefits
 
Post-retirement Benefits
   
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Discount rate
 
4.50%
5.00%
 
4.50%
4.80%
Expected return on plan assets
 
7.00%
7.00%
 
N/A
N/A
Rate of compensation increase
 
3.50%
3.50%
 
N/A
N/A

The net periodic benefit cost as of December 31 is as follows:

   
Pension Benefits
 
Post-retirement Benefits
(000's omitted)
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
Service cost
 
$3,530
$3,988
$3,392
 
$0
$0
$0
Interest cost
 
5,271
4,120
4,393
 
102
88
114
Expected return on plan assets
 
(11,922)
(10,149)
(9,196)
 
0
0
0
Amortization of unrecognized net (gain) loss
 
(307)
4,028
3,687
 
(7)
12
11
Amortization of prior service cost
 
5
75
(147)
 
(179)
(179)
(822)
Net periodic benefit cost
 
($3,423)
$2,062
$2,129
 
($84)
($79)
($697)

Prior service costs in which all or almost all of the plan’s participants are fully eligible for benefits under the plan are amortized on a straight-line basis over the expected future working years of all active plan participants.  Unrecognized gains or losses are amortized using the “corridor approach”, which is the minimum amortization required. Under the corridor approach, the net gain or loss in excess of 10 percent of the greater of the projected benefit obligation or the market-related value of the assets is amortized on a straight-line basis over the expected future working years of all active plan participants.

The weighted-average assumptions used to determine the net periodic pension cost for the years ended December 31 are as follows:
 
   
Pension Benefits
 
Post-retirement Benefits
   
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
Discount rate
 
5.00%
3.40%
4.10%
 
4.80%
3.20%
3.90%
Expected return on plan assets
 
7.00%
7.00%
7.50%
 
N/A
N/A
N/A
Rate of compensation increase
 
3.50%
3.50%
4.00%
 
N/A
N/A
N/A


 
75

 


The amount of benefit payments that are expected to be paid over the next ten years are as follows:

 
Pension
Post-retirement
(000's omitted)
Benefits
Benefits
2015
$6,619
$197
2016
6,851
180
2017
7,236
178
2018
7,589
177
2019
8,092
165
2020-2024
45,520
749

The payments reflect future service and are based on various assumptions including retirement age and form of payment (lump-sum versus annuity). Actual results may differ from these estimates.

The assumed discount rate is used to reflect the time value of future benefit obligations.  The discount rate was determined based upon the yield on high-quality fixed income investments expected to be available during the period to maturity of the pension benefits.  This rate is sensitive to changes in interest rates.  A decrease in the discount rate would increase the Company’s obligation and future expense while an increase would have the opposite effect.   The expected long-term rate of return was estimated by taking into consideration asset allocation, reviewing historical returns on the type of assets held and current economic factors.  Based on the Company’s anticipation of future experience under the defined benefit pension plan, the mortality tables used to determine future benefit obligations under the plan were updated as of December 31, 2014 to the RP-2014 Mortality Table for annuitants and non-annuitants, fully generational with projected mortality improvements using Scale MP-2014, with no collar adjustment.  The appropriateness of the assumptions is reviewed annually.

Plan Assets
The investment objective for the defined benefit pension plan is to achieve an average annual total return over a five-year period equal to the assumed rate of return used in the actuarial calculations.  At a minimum performance level, the portfolio should earn the return obtainable on high quality intermediate-term bonds.  The Company’s perspective regarding portfolio assets combines both preservation of capital and moderate risk-taking.   Asset allocation favors equities, with a target allocation of approximately 60% equity securities and 40% fixed income securities.  In order to diversify the risk within the pension portfolio, the pension committee authorized that up to 15% of the assets may be in alternative investments, which may include hedge funds.  No more than 10% of the portfolio can be in stock of the Company.  Due to the volatility in the market, the target allocation is not always desirable and asset allocations will fluctuate between acceptable ranges.  Prohibited transactions include purchase of securities on margin, uncovered call options, and short sale transactions.

The fair values of the Company’s defined benefit pension plan assets at December 31, 2014 by asset category are as follows:

 
 
 
Asset category (000’s omitted)
Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical
Assets Level 1
Significant Observable
Inputs
 Level 2
Significant Unobservable
Inputs
 Level 3
 
 
 
Total
         
Money Market Accounts
$431
$12,470
$0
$12,901
Equity securities:
       
     U.S. large-cap
51,197
0
0
51,197
     U.S mid/small cap
14,026
0
0
14,026
     CBSI stock
15,354
0
0
15,354
     International
28,891
0
0
28,891
 
109,468
0
0
109,468
         
Fixed income securities:
       
     Government securities
6,491
6,646
0
13,137
     Investment grade bonds
21,539
0
0
21,539
     International bonds
5,085
0
0
5,085
     High yield(a)
7,197
0
0
7,197
 
40,312
6,646
0
46,958
         
    Other investments (b)
8,154
70
0
8,224
         
Total (c)
$158,365
$19,186
$0
$177,551
 
 
 
76

 
 
The fair values of the Company’s defined benefit pension plan assets at December 31, 2013 by asset category are as follows:

 
 
 
Asset category (000’s omitted)
Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical Assets
Level 1
Significant Observable
Inputs
 Level 2
Significant Unobservable Inputs
 Level 3
 
 
 
Total
         
Money Market Accounts
$709 
$10,231 
$0 
$10,940
Equity securities:
       
     U.S. large-cap
50,513 
50,513
     U.S mid/small cap
19,308 
19,308
     CBSI stock
9,913 
9,913
     International
33,485 
33,485
 
113,219 
113,219
         
Fixed income securities:
       
     Government securities
7,676 
6,814 
14,490
     Investment grade bonds
17,400 
17,400
     International bonds
2,712 
2,712
     High yield(a)
14,243 
14,243
 
42,031 
6,814 
48,845
         
    Other investments (b)
77 
77
         
Total (c)
$155,959 
$17,122 
$0 
$173,081
 
(a)  
This category is exchange-traded funds representing a diversified index of high yield
corporate bonds.
(b)  
This category is comprised of non-traditional investment classes including private
equity funds and alternative exchange funds.
(c)  
Excludes dividends and interest receivable totaling $314,000 and $335,000 at
December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

The Company makes contributions to its funded qualified pension plan as required by government regulation or as deemed appropriate by management after considering the fair value of plan assets, expected return on such assets, and the value of the accumulated benefit obligation.  The Company made a contribution to its defined benefit pension plan of $10 million during the third quarter of 2013.  The Company funds the payment of benefit obligations for the supplemental pension and post-retirement plans because such plans do not hold assets for investment.

Tupper Lake National Bank (“TLNB”), acquired in 2007, participated in the Pentegra Defined Benefit Plan for Financial Institutions (“Pentegra DB Plan”), a multi-employer tax qualified defined benefit pension plan.  The identification number and plan number of the Pentegra DB Plan are 13-5645888 and 333, respectively. All employees of TLNB who met minimum service requirements participated in the plan.  As of June 30, 2013, the Pentegra DB Plan had total assets of $3.0 billion, actuarial present value of accumulated benefits of $3.0 billion and was at least 80 percent funded.  The assets of the multi-employer plan may be used to satisfy obligations of any of the employers participating in the plan.  As a result, contributions made by the Company may be used to provide benefits to participants of other participating employers.  Contributions for 2014, 2013 and 2012 were $59,000, $22,000 and $53,000, respectively. Contributions made by the Company to the Pentegra DB Plan do not represent more than 5% of contributions made to the Pentegra DB Plan.

The assumed health care cost trend rate used in the post-retirement health plan at December 31, 2014 was 8.00% for the pre-65 participants and 6.00% for the post-65 participants for medical costs and 9.00% for prescription drugs.  The rate to which the cost trend rate is assumed to decline (the ultimate trend rate) and the year that the rate reaches the ultimate trend rate is 5.0% and 2024, respectively.

Assumed health care cost trend rates impact the amounts reported for the health care plan.  A one-percentage-point increase in the trend rate would increase the service and interest cost components by $100 and increase the benefit obligation by $2,000.  A one-percentage-point decrease in the trend rate would decrease the service and interest cost components by $100 and decrease the benefit obligation by $2,000.


 
77

 


401(k) Employee Stock Ownership Plan
The Company has a 401(k) Employee Stock Ownership Plan in which employees can contribute from 1% to 90% of eligible compensation, with the first 3% being eligible for a 100% matching contribution in the form of Company common stock and the next 3% being eligible for a 50% matching contributions in the form of Company common stock.  The expense recognized under this plan for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 was $3,405,000, $3,215,000, and $2,956,000, respectively.  Effective January 1, 2010 the defined benefit pension plan was modified to a new plan design that includes an interest credit contribution to be made to the 401(k) plan.  The expense recognized for this interest credit contribution for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 was $858,000, $650,000 and $419,000, respectively.

Other Deferred Compensation Arrangements
In addition to the supplemental pension plans for certain executives, the Company has nonqualified deferred compensation arrangements for several former directors, officers and key employees.  All benefits provided under these plans are unfunded and payments to plan participants are made by the Company.  At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company has recorded a liability of $3,895,000 and $4,238,000, respectively.  The (income)/expense recognized under these plans for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012 was $330,000, ($52,000), and $439,000, respectively.

Deferred Compensation Plan for Directors
Directors may defer all or a portion of their director fees under the Deferred Compensation Plan for Directors.  Under this plan, there is a separate account for each participating director which is credited with the amount of shares that could have been purchased with the director’s fees as well as any dividends on such shares.  On the distribution date, the director will receive common stock equal to the accumulated share balance in his account.  As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, there were 147,934 and 153,396 shares credited to the participants’ accounts, for which a liability of $3,525,000 and $3,424,000 was accrued, respectively.  The expense recognized under the plan for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, was $168,000, $162,000, and $148,000, respectively.

NOTE L:  STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS

The Company has a long-term incentive program for directors, officers and employees.  Under this program, the Company initially authorized 4,000,000 shares of Company common stock for the grant of incentive stock options, nonqualified stock options, restricted stock awards, and retroactive stock appreciation rights.  The long-term incentive program was amended effective May 25, 2011 and May 14, 2014 to authorize an additional 900,000 shares and 1,000,000 shares of Company common stock, respectively, for the grant of incentive stock options, nonqualified stock options, restricted stock awards, and retroactive stock appreciation rights.    As of December 31, 2014, the Company has authorization to grant up to 1,723,456 additional shares of Company common stock for these instruments.  The nonqualified (offset) stock options in its Director’s Stock Balance Plan vest and become exercisable immediately and expire one year after the date the director retires or two years in the event of death.  The remaining options have a ten-year term, and vest and become exercisable on a grant-by-grant basis, ranging from immediate vesting to ratably over a five-year period.
 
Activity in this long-term incentive program is as follows:
 
 
Stock Options
   
Weighted-average
   
Exercise Price of
 
Outstanding
Shares
Outstanding at December 31, 2012
2,760,723
$22.86
Granted
369,589
29.79
Exercised
(840,556)
22.70
Forfeited
(14,865)
24.45
Outstanding at December 31, 2013
2,274,891
24.03
Granted
281,603
37.77
Exercised
(380,265)
23.19
Forfeited
(24,453)
28.71
Outstanding at December 31, 2014
2,151,776
$25.92
Exercisable at December 31, 2014
1,396,303
$23.12
 


 
78

 


 
The following table summarizes the information about stock options outstanding under the Company’s stock option plan at December 31, 2014:
 
 
Options outstanding
 
Options exercisable 
 
Range of Exercise
Price
 
Shares
Weighted
-average
Exercise
Price
Weighted-
average
Remaining
Life (years)
 
 
Shares
Weighted
-average
Exercise
Price
    $0.00 – $18.00
163,916  
$17.60  
4.15  
 
163,916  
$17.60  
$18.001 – $23.00
629,242  
19.63  
3.72  
 
579,234  
19.64  
$23.001 – $28.00
433,612  
25.55  
4.45  
 
355,440  
25.16  
$28.001 – $29.00
304,939  
28.78  
7.22  
 
145,582  
28.78  
$29.001 – $30.00
342,654  
29.79  
8.21  
 
108,559  
29.79  
$30.001 – $40.00
277,413  
37.77  
9.22  
 
43,572  
37.77  
TOTAL
2,151,776  
$25.92  
5.82  
 
1,396,303  
$23.12  

The weighted-average remaining contractual term of outstanding and exercisable stock options at December 31, 2014 is 5.8 years and 4.7 years, respectively.  The aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding and exercisable stock options at December 31, 2014 is $26.3 million and $21.0 million, respectively.

The Company recognized stock-based compensation expense related to incentive and non-qualified stock options of $2.0 million, $2.0 million and $1.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.  A related income tax benefit was recognized of $0.9 million, $1.1 million and $0.8 million for the 2014, 2013 and 2012 years, respectively.  Compensation expense related to restricted stock vesting recognized in the income statement for 2014, 2013 and 2012 was approximately $2.0 million, $2.0 million and $1.8 million, respectively.

Management estimated the fair value of options granted using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model.  This model was originally developed to estimate the fair value of exchange-traded equity options, which (unlike employee stock options) have no vesting period or transferability restrictions.  As a result, the Black-Scholes model is not necessarily a precise indicator of the value of an option, but it is commonly used for this purpose.  The Black-Scholes model requires several assumptions, which management developed based on historical trends and current market observations.

 
2014
2013
2012
Weighted-average Fair Value of Options Granted
$8.38
$6.24
$6.40
Assumptions:
     
     Weighted-average expected life (in years)
6.50
7.23
7.40
     Future dividend yield
3.70%
3.90%
3.90%
     Share price volatility
30.71%
31.21%
31.79%
     Weighted-average risk-free interest rate
2.69%
1.91%
2.34%

Unrecognized stock-based compensation expense related to non-vested stock options totaled $3.8 million at December 31, 2014, which will be recognized as expense over the next five years.  The weighted-average period over which this unrecognized expense would be recognized is 2.8 years.  The total fair value of stock options vested during 2014, 2013, and 2012 were $1.9 million, $2.0 million and $1.7 million, respectively.

During the 12 months ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, proceeds from stock option exercises totaled $9.4 million and $16.0 million, respectively, and the related tax benefits from exercise were approximately $1.6 million and $1.6 million, respectively.   During the twelve months ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, 359,679 and 680,705 shares, respectively, were issued in connection with stock option exercises.  The total intrinsic value of options exercised during 2014, 2013 and 2012 were $5.7 million, $7.9 million and $4.9 million, respectively.


 
79

 


A summary of the status of the Company’s unvested restricted stock awards as of December 31, 2014, and changes during the twelve months ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, is presented below:

 
Restricted
Shares
Weighted-average
grant date fair value
Unvested at December 31, 2012
192,083 
$23.98
Awards
142,353 
22.13
Forfeitures
(2,896) 
25.34
Vestings
(70,575) 
22.28
Unvested at December 31, 2013
260,965 
23.42
Awards
53,518 
37.77
Forfeitures
(4,329) 
29.98
Vestings
(64,433) 
24.55
Unvested at December 31, 2014
245,721 
$26.13

NOTE M:  EARNINGS PER SHARE

Basic earnings per share are computed based on the weighted-average of the common shares outstanding for the period.  Diluted earnings per share are based on the weighted-average of the shares outstanding adjusted for the dilutive effect of restricted stock and the assumed exercise of stock options during the year.  The dilutive effect of options is calculated using the treasury stock method of accounting.  The treasury stock method determines the number of common shares that would be outstanding if all the dilutive options (those where the average market price is greater than the exercise price) were exercised and the proceeds were used to repurchase common shares in the open market at the average market price for the applicable time period.  There were approximately 0.2 million, 0.3 million and 0.5 million weighted-average anti-dilutive stock options outstanding at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, which were not included in the computation below.

The following is a reconciliation of basic to diluted earnings per share for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.

(000's omitted, except per share data)
2014
2013
2012
Net income
$91,353
$78,829
$77,068
Income attributable to unvested stock-based compensation awards
(456)
(433)
(499)
Income available to common shareholders
$90,897
$78,396
$76,569
       
Weighted-average common shares outstanding - basic
40,548
40,000
39,192
       
Basic earnings per share
$2.24
$1.96
$1.95
       
Net income
$91,353
$78,829
$77,068
Income attributable to unvested stock-based compensation awards
(456)
(433)
(499)
Income available to common shareholders
$90,897
$78,396
$76,569
       
Weighted-average common shares outstanding
40,548
40,000
39,192
Assumed exercise of stock options
481
504
479
Weighted-average common shares outstanding – diluted
41,029
40,504
39,671
       
Diluted earnings per share
$2.22
$1.94
$1.93
Cash dividends declared per share
$1.16
$1.10
$1.06

In late January 2012, the Company completed a public common stock offering and raised $57.5 million through the issuance of 2.13 million shares of the Company’s common stock.  The net proceeds of the offering were approximately $54.9 million.  The Company used the capital raised in this offering to support the HSBC and First Niagara branch acquisitions.

Stock Repurchase Program
At its December 2011 meeting, the Board approved a stock repurchase program authorizing the repurchase, at the discretion of senior management, of up to 1,500,000 shares through December 31, 2012.  At its December 2012 meeting, the Board approved a new repurchase program authorizing the repurchase of up to 2,000,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, in accordance with securities laws and regulations, through December 31, 2013.  At its December 2014 meeting, the Board approved a new repurchase program authorizing the repurchase of up to 2,000,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, in accordance with securities laws and regulations, through December 31, 2015.  Any repurchased shares will be used for general corporate purposes, including those related to stock plan activities.  The timing and extent of repurchases will depend on market conditions and other corporate considerations as determined at the Company’s discretion.  During 2014 the Company repurchased 123,000 shares of its common stock in open market transactions.  There were no treasury stock purchases in 2013 or 2012.
 
 
 
80

 
 
NOTE N:  COMMITMENTS, CONTINGENT LIABILITIES AND RESTRICTIONS

The Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance-sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers.  These financial instruments consist primarily of commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit.  Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to customers, generally having fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses that may require payment of a fee.  These commitments consist principally of unused commercial and consumer credit lines.  Standby letters of credit generally are contingent upon the failure of the customer to perform according to the terms of an underlying contract with a third party.  The credit risks associated with commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit are essentially the same as that involved with extending loans to customers and are subject to the Company’s normal credit policies.  Collateral may be obtained based on management’s assessment of the customer’s creditworthiness.  The fair value of the standby letters of credit is immaterial for disclosure.

The contract amounts of commitments and contingencies are as follows at December 31:

 (000's omitted)
2014
2013
Commitments to extend credit
$733,827
$704,904
Standby letters of credit
23,916
24,449
     Total
$757,743
$729,353

The Company has unused lines of credit of $25.0 million at December 31, 2014.  The Company has unused borrowing capacity of approximately $0.8 billion through collateralized transactions with the FHLB and $9.8 million through collateralized transactions with the Federal Reserve Bank.

The Company is required to maintain a reserve balance, as established by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York.  The required average total reserve for the 14-day maintenance period of December 25, 2014 through January 7, 2015 was $64.1 million, with $60.0 million represented by cash on hand and the remaining $4.1 million was required to be on deposit with the Federal Reserve Bank of New York.

The Company and its subsidiaries are subject in the normal course of business to various pending and threatened legal proceedings in which claims for monetary damages are asserted. As of December 31, 2014, management, after consultation with legal counsel, does not anticipate that the aggregate ultimate liability arising out of litigation pending or threatened against the Company or its subsidiaries will be material to the Company’s consolidated financial position. On at least a quarterly basis the Company assesses its liabilities and contingencies in connection with such legal proceedings. For those matters where it is probable that the Company will incur losses and the amounts of the losses can be reasonably estimated, the Company records an expense and corresponding liability in its consolidated financial statements. To the extent the pending or threatened litigation could result in exposure in excess of that liability, the amount of such excess is not currently estimable. The range of reasonably possible losses for matters where an exposure is not currently estimable or considered probable, beyond the existing recorded liabilities, is between $0 and $1 million in the aggregate. Although the Company does not believe that the outcome of pending litigation will be material to the Company’s consolidated financial position, it cannot rule out the possibility that such outcomes will be material to the consolidated results of operations for a particular reporting period in the future.

The Bank reached an agreement in principle to settle two related class actions pending in the United States District Court for the Middle District of Pennsylvania which were commenced October 30, 2013 and May 29, 2014, respectively.  The first action alleged that notices provided by the Bank in connection with the repossession of the named plaintiff’s automobile failed to comply with certain requirements of the Pennsylvania and New York Uniform Commercial Code (UCC) and related statutes.  The plaintiff sought to pursue the action as a class action on behalf of herself and similarly situated plaintiffs who had their automobiles repossessed and sought to recover statutory damages under the UCC. The second action filed May 29, 2014 contained similar allegations, which the plaintiff also sought to pursue as a class action for statutory damages. In both cases, the Bank contested the allegations that the notices were deficient, asserted various legal defenses and counterclaims, and opposed class certification in both of the cases.  On September 30, 2014, the Bank reached an agreement in principle to settle both actions for $2.8 million in exchange for releases of all claims.  The settlement is subject to final documentation, notice to the class members and Court approval. A litigation settlement charge of $2.8 million with respect to the settlement of the class actions was recorded in the third quarter of 2014, and is included in the Other expenses line item in the Consolidated Statements of Income.


 
81

 


NOTE O:  LEASES

The Company leases buildings, office space, and equipment under agreements that expire in various years.  Rental expense included in operating expenses amounted to $5.3 million, $5.2 million and $4.9 million in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.  The future minimum rental commitments as of December 31, 2014 for all non-cancelable operating leases are as follows:

2015
$5,497
2016
5,363
2017
4,639
2018
3,858
2019
2,745
Thereafter
3,568
  Total
$25,670

NOTE P:  REGULATORY MATTERS

The Company and the Bank are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal banking agencies.  Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Company’s financial statements.  Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Company and the Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the Company’s and the Bank’s assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices.  The Company’s and the Bank's capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company and Bank to maintain minimum total core capital to risk-weighted assets of 8%, and Tier I capital to risk-weighted assets and Tier I capital to average assets of 4%.  Management believes, as of December 31, 2014, that the Company and Bank meet all capital adequacy requirements to which they are subject.

As of December 31, 2014, the most recent notification from the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) categorized the Company and Bank as “well capitalized” under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action.  To be categorized as “well capitalized,” the Company and Bank must maintain minimum total core capital to risk-weighted assets of 10%, Tier I capital to risk-weighted assets of 6% and Tier I capital to average assets of 5%.  There are no conditions or events since that notification that management believes have changed the institution’s category.

The capital ratios and amounts of the Company and the Bank as of December 31 are presented below:
   
2014
 
2013
(000's omitted)
 
Company
Bank
 
Company
Bank
Tier 1 capital to average assets
           
  Amount
 
$705,163
$584,014
 
$643,286
$547,464
  Ratio
 
9.96%
8.27%
 
9.29%
7.93%
  Minimum required amount
 
$283,255
$282,517
 
$276,918
$276,226
             
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets
           
  Amount
 
$705,163
$584,014
 
$643,286
$547,464
  Ratio
 
17.61%
14.64%
 
16.42%
14.03%
  Minimum required amount
 
$160,214
$159,603
 
$156,661
$156,083
             
Total core capital to risk-weighted assets
           
  Amount
 
$750,942
$629,793
 
$687,946
$592,124
  Ratio
 
18.75%
15.78%
 
17.57%
15.17%
  Minimum required amount
 
$320,428
$319,206
 
$313,322
$312,166


 
82

 


NOTE Q:  PARENT COMPANY STATEMENTS

The condensed balance sheets of the parent company at December 31 are as follows:

(000's omitted) 
2014
2013
Assets:
   
  Cash and cash equivalents
$106,957
$83,783
  Investment securities
3,622
3,601
  Investment in and advances to subsidiaries
984,561
895,211
  Other assets
9,608
8,847
     Total assets
$1,104,748
$991,442
     
Liabilities and shareholders' equity:
   
  Accrued interest and other liabilities
$14,722
$13,533
  Borrowings
102,122
102,097
  Shareholders' equity
987,904
875,812
     Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
$1,104,748
$991,442

The condensed statements of income of the parent company for the years ended December 31 is as follows:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
2012
Revenues:
     
  Dividends from subsidiaries
$61,100
$66,000
$0
  Interest and dividends on investments
88
91
98
  Other income
0
9
198
        Total revenues
61,188
66,100
296
Expenses:
     
  Interest on borrowings
2,477
2,520
2,716
  Other expenses
37
61
155
        Total expenses
2,514
2,581
2,871
       
(Loss) Income before tax benefit and equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
58,674
63,519
(2,575)
Income tax benefit
581
862
1,274
  (Loss) Income before equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
59,255
64,381
(1,301)
Equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
32,098
14,448
78,369
Net income
$91,353
$78,829
$77,068
Comprehensive (loss)/income
$148,619
($2,051)
$102,237


 
83

 


The statements of cash flows of the parent company for the years ended December 31 is as follows:

(000's omitted)
2014
2013
2012
Operating activities:
     
  Net income
$91,353
$78,829
$77,068
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities
     
    (Gain)/loss on sale of investments
0
(9)
0
    Equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
(32,098)
(14,448)
(78,369)
    Net change in other assets and other liabilities
(479)
(221)
(746)
       Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
58,776
64,151
(2,047)
Investing activities:
     
  Purchase of investment securities
0
0
(3)
  Proceeds from sale of investment securities
3
114
30
  Capital contributions to subsidiaries
0
0
(20,081)
       Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
3
114
(20,054)
Financing activities:
     
  Issuance of common stock
13,982
19,200
67,813
  Purchase of treasury stock
(4,368)
0
0
  Sale of treasury stock
959
0
0
  Cash dividends paid
(46,178)
(43,482)
(40,765)
       Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
(35,605)
(24,282)
27,048
Change in cash and cash equivalents
23,174
39,983
4,947
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
83,783
43,800
38,853
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
$106,957
$83,783
$43,800
       
Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information:
     
  Cash paid for interest
$2,473
$2,521
$2,738
Supplemental disclosures of noncash financing activities
     
  Dividends declared and unpaid
$12,254
$11,332
$10,699

NOTE R:  FAIR VALUE

Accounting standards allow entities an irrevocable option to measure certain financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value.  Unrealized gains and losses on items for which the fair value option has been elected are reported in earnings.  The Company has elected to value mortgage loans held for sale at fair value in order to more closely match the gains and losses associated with loans held for sale with the gains and losses on forward sales contracts.  Accordingly, the impact on the valuation will be recognized in the Company’s consolidated statement of income.  All mortgage loans held for sale are current and in performing status.

Accounting standards establish a framework for measuring fair value and require certain disclosures about such fair value instruments.  It defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (i.e. exit price).  Inputs used to measure fair value are classified into the following hierarchy:

●  
Level 1 – Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.
●  
Level 2 – Quoted prices in active markets for similar assets or liabilities, or quoted prices for identical or similar assets or 
                 liabilities in markets that are not active, or inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability.
●  
Level 3 – Significant valuation assumptions not readily observable in a market.


 
84

 


A financial instrument’s categorization within the valuation hierarchy is based upon the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement.  The following tables set forth the Company’s financial assets and liabilities that were accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis.  There were no transfers between any of the levels for the periods presented.

 
December 31, 2014
(000's omitted)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total Fair Value
Available-for-sale investment securities:
       
   U.S. Treasury and agency securities
$1,496,667
$21,066
$0
$1,517,733
   Obligations of state and political subdivisions
0
671,903
0
671,903
   Government agency mortgage-backed securities
0
237,728
0
237,728
   Corporate debt securities
0
27,091
0
27,091
   Government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
0
18,025
0
18,025
   Marketable equity securities
445
0
0
445
      Total available-for-sale investment securities
1,497,112
975,813
0
2,472,925
Mortgage loans held for sale
0
1,042
0
1,042
Commitments to originate real estate loans for sale
0
0
185
185
Forward sales commitments
0
(43)
0
(43)
Total $1,497,112 $976,812   $185   $2,474,109  
 
 
December 31, 2013
(000's omitted)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total Fair Value
Available-for-sale investment securities:
       
   U.S. Treasury and agency securities
$1,182,261
$29,886
$0
$1,212,147
   Obligations of state and political subdivisions
0
668,982
0
668,982
   Government agency mortgage-backed securities
0
254,978
0
254,978
   Corporate debt securities
0
27,587
0
27,587
   Government agency collateralized mortgage obligations
0
22,048
0
22,048
   Marketable equity securities
421
0
0
421
      Total available-for-sale investment securities
1,182,682
1,003,481
0
2,186,163
Mortgage loans held for sale
0
728
0
728
Commitments to originate real estate loans for sale
0
0
44
44
Forward sales commitments
0
27
0
27
Total
$1,182,682
$1,004,236
$44
$2,186,962
 
The valuation techniques used to measure fair value for the items in the table above are as follows:
 
●  
Available for sale investment securities – The fair value of available-for-sale investment securities is based upon quoted prices, if available.  If quoted prices are not available, fair values are measured using quoted market prices for similar securities or model-based valuation techniques.  Level 1 securities include U.S. Treasury obligations and marketable equity securities that are traded by dealers or brokers in active over-the-counter markets.  Level 2 securities include U.S. agency securities, mortgage-backed securities issued by government-sponsored entities, municipal securities and corporate debt securities that are valued by reference to prices for similar securities or through model-based techniques in which all significant inputs, such as reported trades, trade execution data, LIBOR swap yield curve, market prepayment speeds, credit information, market spreads, and security’s terms and conditions, are observable.  See Note C for further disclosure of the fair value of investment securities.
 
●  
Mortgage loans held for sale – Mortgage loans held for sale are carried at fair value, which is determined using quoted secondary-market prices of loans with similar characteristics and, as such, have been classified as a Level 2 valuation.  The unpaid principal value of mortgage loans held for sale at December 31, 2014 is approximately $1.0 million.  The unrealized gain on mortgage loans held for sale of approximately $0.07 million was recognized in other banking services in the Consolidated Statement of Income for the year ended December 31, 2014.
 
●  
Forward sales commitments – The Company enters into forward sales commitments to sell certain residential real estate loans.  Such commitments are considered to be derivative financial instruments and, therefore, are carried at estimated fair value in the other asset or other liability section of the consolidated balance sheet.  The fair value of these forward sales commitments is primarily measured by obtaining pricing from certain government-sponsored entities and reflects the underlying price the entity would pay the Company for an immediate sale on these mortgages.  As such, these instruments are classified as Level 2 in the fair value hierarchy.
 
 
 
85

 
 
●  
Commitments to originate real estate loans for sale – The Company enters into various commitments to originate residential real estate loans for sale.  Such commitments are considered to be derivative financial instruments and, therefore, are carried at estimated fair value in the other asset or other liability section of the consolidated balance sheet.  The estimated fair value of these commitments is determined using quoted secondary market prices obtained from certain government-sponsored entities.  Additionally, accounting guidance requires the expected net future cash flows related to the associated servicing of the loan to be included in the fair value measurement of the derivative.  The expected net future cash flows are based on a valuation model that calculates the present value of estimated net servicing income.  The valuation model incorporates assumptions that market participants would use in estimating future net servicing income.  Such assumptions include estimates of the cost of servicing loans, appropriate discount rate and prepayment speeds.  The determination of expected net cash flows is considered a significant unobservable input contributing to the Level 3 classification of commitments to originate real estate loans for sale.

 The changes in Level 3 assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis are summarized in the following tables:
 
       
Year Ended December 31,
 
2014
   2013
(000's omitted)
Commitments
to Originate
Real Estate
Loans for Sale
 
Pooled Trust Preferred Securities
Commitments
to Originate
Real Estate
Loans for Sale
 
 
 
Total
Beginning balance
$44
 
$49,600
$0 
$49,600
Total (losses)/gains included in earnings (1)(3)
(423)
 
(15,201)
(249) 
(15,450)
Total gains included in other comprehensive income(2)
0
 
12,379
12,379   
Principal reductions
0
 
(5,944)
(5,944)
Sales
0
 
(40,834)
(40,834)
Commitments to originate real estate loans held for sale, net
564
 
0
293 
293   
Ending balance
$185
 
$0
$44 
$44   
 
(1) Amounts included in earnings associated with the pooled trust preferred securities relate to accretion of related
     discount, which are reported in interest and dividends on taxable investments
(2) Amounts included in other comprehensive income associated with the pooled trust preferred securities relate
     to changes in unrealized loss and are reported as a component of net unrealized gains/(losses) on
     available-for-sale securities in the Statement of Comprehensive Income.
(3) Amounts included in earnings associated with the commitments to originate real estate loans for sale are reported
     as a component of other banking services in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
 
 
Assets and liabilities measured on a non-recurring basis:

 
December 31, 2014
 
December 31, 2013
(000's omitted)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total Fair
Value
 
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total Fair
Value
Impaired loans
$0
$0
$0
$0
 
$0
$600
$0
$600
Other real estate owned
0
0
1,855
1,855
 
0
0
5,060
5,060
   Total
$0
$0
$1,855
$1,855
 
$0
$600
$5,060
$5,660

Loans are generally not recorded at fair value on a recurring basis.  Periodically, the Company records nonrecurring adjustments to the carrying value of loans based on fair value measurements for partial charge-offs of the uncollectible portions of those loans.  Nonrecurring adjustments also include certain impairment amounts for collateral-dependent loans calculated when establishing the allowance for credit losses. Such amounts are generally based on the fair value of the underlying collateral supporting the loan and, as a result, the carrying value of the loan less the calculated valuation amount does not necessarily represent the fair value of the loan. Real estate collateral is typically valued using independent appraisals or other indications of value based on recent comparable sales of similar properties or assumptions generally observable in the marketplace, adjusted for non-observable inputs.  Thus, the resulting nonrecurring fair value measurements are generally classified as Level 3. Estimates of fair value used for other collateral supporting commercial loans generally are based on assumptions not observable in the marketplace and, therefore, such valuations classify as Level 3.  At December 31, 2014, there were no impaired loans recorded at fair value.  As such, no unobservable inputs were utilized.


 
86

 


Other real estate owned (“OREO”) is valued at the time the loan is foreclosed upon and the asset is transferred to OREO. The value is based primarily on third party appraisals, less estimated costs to sell. The appraisals are sometimes further discounted based on management’s historical knowledge, changes in market conditions from the time of valuation, and/or management’s expertise and knowledge of the customer and customer’s business. Such discounts are significant, ranging from 10% to 78% at December 31, 2014, and result in a Level 3 classification of the inputs for determining fair value. OREO is reviewed and evaluated on at least a quarterly basis for additional impairment and adjusted accordingly, based on the same factors identified above. The Company recovers the carrying value of OREO through the sale of the property. The ability to affect future sales prices is subject to market conditions and factors beyond the Company’s control and may impact the estimated fair value of a property.

Originated mortgage servicing rights are recorded at their fair value at the time of sale of the underlying loan, and are amortized in proportion to and over the estimated period of net servicing income.  The fair value of mortgage servicing rights is based on a valuation model incorporating inputs that market participants would use in estimating future net servicing income.  Such inputs include estimates of the cost of servicing loans, appropriate discount rate, and prepayment speeds and are considered to be unobservable and contribute to the Level 3 classification of mortgage servicing rights.    In accordance with GAAP, the Company must record impairment charges, on a nonrecurring basis, when the carrying value of a stratum exceeds its estimated fair value.  Impairment is recognized through a valuation allowance.  There is no valuation allowance at December 31, 2014 as the fair value of mortgage servicing rights of approximately $1.6 million exceeded the carrying value of approximately $1.1 million.

The Company evaluates goodwill for impairment on an annual basis, or more often if events or circumstances indicate there may be impairment.  The fair value of each reporting unit is compared to the carrying amount of that reporting unit in order to determine if impairment is indicated.  If so, the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill is compared to its carrying amount and the impairment loss is measured by the excess of the carrying value of the goodwill over fair value of the goodwill.  In such situations, the Company performs a discounted cash flow modeling technique that requires management to make estimates regarding the amount and timing of expected future cash flows of the assets and liabilities of the reporting unit that enable the Company to calculate the implied fair value of the goodwill.  It also requires use of a discount rate that reflects the current return expectation of the market in relation to present risk-free interest rates, expected equity market premiums, peer volatility indicators and company-specific risk indicators.  The Company did not recognize an impairment charge during 2014 or 2013.

The significant unobservable inputs used in the determination of fair value of assets classified as Level 3 on a recurring or non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2014 are as follows:

(000's omitted)
Fair Value
Valuation Technique
Significant Unobservable Inputs
Significant Unobservable
Input Range
(Weighted Average)
         
Other real estate owned
$1,855  
Fair value of collateral  
Estimated cost of disposal/market adjustment   
10.0% - 77.5% (30.6%)   
         
Commitments to originate        
   real estate loans for sale
185     
Discounted cash flow  
Embedded servicing value   
1%   

The significant unobservable inputs used in the determination of fair value of assets classified as Level 3 on a recurring or non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2013 are as follows:

(000's omitted)
Fair Value
Valuation Technique
Significant Unobservable Inputs
Significant Unobservable
Input Range
(Weighted Average)
         
Other real estate owned
$5,060  
Fair value of collateral  
Estimated cost of disposal/market adjustment   
11.0% - 54.4% (28.1%)   
         
Commitments to originate        
   real estate loans for sale
44     
Discounted cash flow  
Embedded servicing value   
1%   

The Company determines fair values based on quoted market values, where available, estimates of present values, or other valuation techniques.  Those techniques are significantly affected by the assumptions used, including, but not limited to, the discount rate and estimates of future cash flows.  In that regard, the derived fair value estimates cannot be substantiated by comparison to independent markets and, in many cases, may not be realized in immediate settlement of the instrument.  Certain financial instruments and all nonfinancial instruments are excluded from fair value disclosure requirements.  Accordingly, the aggregate fair value amounts presented do not represent the underlying value of the Company.


 
87

 


The carrying amounts and estimated fair values of the Company’s other financial instruments that are not accounted for at fair value at December 31, 2014 and 2013 are as follows:
 
   
December 31, 2014
 
December 31, 2013
   
Carrying
Fair
 
Carrying
Fair
(000's omitted)
 
Value
Value
 
Value
Value
Financial assets:
           
   Net loans
 
$4,190,865
$4,251,565
 
$4,064,764
$4,044,449
Financial liabilities:
           
   Deposits
 
5,935,264
5,935,690
 
5,896,044
5,898,138
   Borrowings
 
338,000
338,000
 
141,913
141,913
   Subordinated debt held by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts
 
102,122
85,189
 
102,097
109,284

The following is a further description of the principal valuation methods used by the Company to estimate the fair values of its financial instruments.
 
Loans have been classified as a Level 3 valuation.  Fair values for variable rate loans that reprice frequently are based on carrying values.  Fair values for fixed rate loans are estimated using discounted cash flows and interest rates currently being offered for loans with similar terms to borrowers of similar credit quality.

Deposits have been classified as a Level 2 valuation.  The fair value of demand deposits, interest-bearing checking deposits, savings accounts and money market deposits is the amount payable on demand at the reporting date.  The fair value of time deposit obligations are based on current market rates for similar products.

Borrowings have been classified as a Level 2 valuation.  The fair value of FHLB overnight advances is the amount payable on demand at the reporting date.  Fair values for long-term borrowings are estimated using discounted cash flows and interest rates currently being offered on similar borrowings.

Subordinated debt held by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts have been classified as a Level 2 valuation.   The fair value of subordinated debt held by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts are estimated using discounted cash flows and interest rates currently being offered on similar securities.

Other financial assets and liabilities – Cash and cash equivalents have been classified as a Level 1 valuation, while accrued interest receivable and accrued interest payable have been classified as a Level 2 valuation.  The fair values of each approximate the respective carrying values because the instruments are payable on demand or have short-term maturities and present relatively low credit risk and interest rate risk.


 
88

 


NOTE S:  DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS

The Company is party to derivative financial instruments in the normal course of its business to meet the financing needs of its customers and to manage its own exposure to fluctuations in interest rates.  These financial instruments have been limited to commitments to originate real estate loans held for sale and forward sales commitments.  The Company does not hold nor issue derivative financial instruments for trading or other speculative purposes.

The Company enters into forward sales commitments for the future delivery of residential mortgage loans, and interest rate lock commitments to fund loans at a specified interest rate.  The forward sales commitments are utilized to reduce interest rate risk associated with interest rate lock commitments and loans held for sale.  Changes in the estimated fair value of the forward sales commitments and interest rate lock commitments subsequent to inception are based on changes in the fair value of the underlying loan resulting from the fulfillment of the commitment and changes in the probability that the loan will fund within the terms of the commitment, which is affected primarily by changes in interest rates and the passage of time.  At inception and during the life of the interest rate lock commitment, the Company includes the expected net future cash flows related to the associated servicing of the loan as part of the fair value measurement of the interest rate lock commitments.  These derivatives are recorded at fair value.

The following table presents the Company’s derivative financial instruments, their estimated fair values, and balance sheet location as of December 31, 2014:

(000's omitted)
 
Location
Notional
Fair Value
Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
       
   Forward sales commitments
 
Other liabilities
$3,077 
($43) 
   Commitments to originate real estate loans for sale
 
Other assets
6,183 
185 
Total derivatives, net
     
$142 

The following table presents the Company’s derivative financial instruments and the location of the net gain or loss recognized in the statement of income for the year ended December 31, 2014:

(000's omitted)
Location
Gain/(Loss) Recognized
in the Statement of
Income for the Year
Ending December 31, 2014
Forward sales commitments
Mortgage banking and other services
($69)
Commitments to originate real estate loans for sale
Mortgage banking and other services
141
Total, net
 
$72


 
89

 


NOTE T:  SEGMENT INFORMATION

Operating segments are components of an enterprise, which are evaluated regularly by the “chief operating decision maker” in deciding how to allocate resources and assess performance.  The Company’s chief operating decision maker is the President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company. The Company has identified Banking, Employee Benefit Services and Wealth Management as its reportable operating business segments.  CBNA operates the banking segment that provides full-service banking to consumers, businesses and governmental units in northern, central and western New York as well as northern Pennsylvania.  Employee benefit services, which includes BPAS, Harbridge, and HB&T, provides employee benefit trust, collective investment fund, retirement plan administration, actuarial, VEBA/HRA and health and welfare consulting services.  Wealth management services activities include trust services provided by the personal trust unit within the Bank, investment and insurance products and services provided by CISI and CBNA Insurance and asset management provided by Nottingham.  The accounting policies used in the disclosure of business segments are the same as those described in the summary of significant accounting policies (See Note A).

Information about reportable segments and reconciliation of the information to the consolidated financial statements follows:

 
(000's omitted) 
Banking
Employee
Benefit Services
Wealth
Management
Eliminations
Consolidated
Total
2014
         
Net interest income
$244,243
$92 
$93
$0
$244,428
Provision for loan losses
7,178
0
0
7,178
Noninterest income
58,565
43,701 
18,634
(1,880)
119,020
Amortization of intangible assets
3,438
647 
202
0
4,287
Other operating expenses
178,472
32,846 
12,855
(1,880)
222,293
Income before income taxes
$113,720
$10,300 
$5,670
$0
$129,690
Assets
$7,463,379
$31,513 
$15,635
($21,087)
$7,489,440
Goodwill
$364,495
$8,019 
$2,660
$0
$375,174
           
2013
         
Net interest income
$237,915
$101 
$78
$0
$238,094
Provision for loan losses
7,992
0
0
7,992
Noninterest income
48,030
39,534 
16,265
(1,649)
102,180
Amortization of intangible assets
3,569
662 
238
0
4,469
Other operating expenses
175,139
31,049 
12,247
(1,649)
216,786
Income before income taxes
$99,245
$7,924 
$3,858
$0
$111,027
Assets
$7,070,866
$27,970 
$13,259
($16,231)
$7,095,864
Goodwill
$364,495
$7,836 
$2,660
$0
$374,991
           
2012
         
Net interest income
$230,251
$104 
$69
$0
$230,424
Provision for loan losses
9,108
0
0
9,108
Noninterest income
50,422
36,781 
13,549
(1,506)
99,246
Amortization of intangible assets
3,548
779 
280
0
4,607
Other operating expenses
167,332
30,617 
10,707
(1,506)
207,150
Income before income taxes
$100,685
$5,489 
$2,631
$0
$108,805
Assets
$7,472,628
$30,405 
$12,101
($18,334)
$7,496,800
Goodwill
$359,207
$7,836 
$2,660
$0
$369,703


 
90

 


Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f).  Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, we conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting based on the framework in Internal Control – Integrated Framework(2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.  Based on our evaluation, management concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2014.

The consolidated financial statements of the Company have been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm that was engaged to express an opinion as to the fairness of presentation of such financial statements.  PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP was also engaged to audit the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.  The report of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP follows this report.

 
Community Bank System, Inc.
 



By:  /s/ Mark E. Tryniski
Mark E. Tryniski,
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director

By:  /s/ Scott  Kingsley
Scott Kingsley,
Treasurer and Chief Financial Officer

 
91

 

 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of
Community Bank System, Inc.

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated statements of condition and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders' equity, and cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Community Bank System, Inc. and its subsidiaries (the "Company") at December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2014 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.  Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company's management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting.  Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits.  We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.  Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.  Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk.  Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.  A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.  Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.


/s/PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

 
March 2, 2015


 
92

 

TWO YEAR SELECTED QUARTERLY DATA (Unaudited)

2014 Results
4th
3rd
2nd
1st
 
(000's omitted, except per share data)
Quarter
Quarter
Quarter
Quarter
Total
Net interest income
$61,756
$61,394
$61,170
$60,108
$244,428
Provision for loan losses
2,531
1,747
1,900
1,000
7,178
  Net interest income after provision for loan losses
59,225
59,647
59,270
59,108
237,250
Noninterest income
29,928
31,072
29,666
28,354
119,020
Operating expenses
56,684
58,811
55,164
55,921
226,580
Income before income taxes
32,469
31,908
33,772
31,541
129,690
Income taxes
9,336
9,537
10,096
9,368
38,337
Net income
$23,133
$22,371
$23,676
$22,173
$91,353
           
Basic earnings per share
$0.57
$0.55
$0.58
$0.55
$2.24
Diluted earnings per share
$0.56
$0.54
$0.57
$0.54
$2.22
           
2013 Results
4th
3rd
2nd
1st
 
(000's omitted, except per share data)
Quarter
Quarter
Quarter
Quarter
Total
Net interest income
$60,636
$60,601
$58,432
$58,425
$238,094
Provision for loan losses
3,185
2,093
1,321
1,393
7,992
  Net interest income after provision for loan losses
57,451
58,508
57,111
57,032
230,102
Noninterest income
21,379
27,594
27,098
26,109
102,180
Operating expenses
57,283
55,044
54,376
54,552
221,255
Income before income taxes
21,547
31,058
29,833
28,589
111,027
Income taxes
6,070
9,069
8,711
8,348
32,198
Net income
$15,477
$21,989
$21,122
$20,241
$78,829
           
Basic earnings per share
$0.38
$0.55
$0.53
$0.51
$1.96
Diluted earnings per share
$0.38
$0.54
$0.52
$0.50
$1.94

Item 9.  Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
None

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
The Company maintains disclosure controls and procedures, as defined in Rule 13a -15(e) and 15d – 15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, designed to: (i) record, process, summarize, and report within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission’s (“SEC”) rules and forms, and (ii) accumulate and communicate to management, including the principal executive and principal financial officers, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding disclosure. Based on evaluation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures, with the participation of the Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) and the Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”), the CEO and CFO have concluded that, as of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K, these disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of December 31, 2014.

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
Management’s annual report on internal control over financial reporting is included under the heading “Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting” at Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Report of the Registered Public Accounting Firm
The report of the Company’s registered public accounting firm is included under the heading “Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” at Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.


 
93

 

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting
The Company continually assesses the adequacy of its internal control over financial reporting and enhances its controls in response to internal control assessments, and internal and external audit and regulatory recommendations.  No change in internal control over financial reporting during the quarter ended December 31, 2014 or through the date of this Annual Report on Form 10-K have materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.  Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate due to changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Item 9B. Other Information

None
 
Part III

Item 10.  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

The information concerning the Directors of the Company required by this Item 10 is incorporated herein by reference to the sections entitled “Nominees for Director and Directors Continuing in Office” in the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement for its 2015 Annual Meeting of Shareholders, which will be filed with the SEC on or about April 1, 2015 (the “Proxy Statement”).  The information concerning executive officers of the Company required by this Item 10 is presented in Item 4A of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.  Disclosure of compliance with Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, by the Company’s directors and executive officers is incorporated by reference to the section entitled “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” in the Proxy Statement.  In addition, information concerning Audit Committee and Audit Committee Financial Expert is included in the Proxy Statement under the caption “Audit Committee Report” and is incorporated herein by reference.

The Company has adopted a code of ethics that applies to its principal executive officer, principal financial officer, principal accounting officer or controller, or persons performing similar functions.  The text of the code of ethics is posted on the Company’s website at www.communitybankna.com, and is available free of charge in print to any person who requests it. The Company intends to satisfy the requirements under Item 5.05 of Form 8-K regarding an amendment to, or a waiver from, the code of ethics that relates to certain elements thereof, by posting such information on its website referenced above.

Item 11.  Executive Compensation

The information required by this Item 11 is incorporated herein by reference to the section entitled “Compensation of Executive Officers” in the Company’s Proxy Statement.

Item 12.  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

The information required by this Item 12 is incorporated herein by reference to the section entitled “Nominees for Director and Directors Continuing in Office” in the Company’s Proxy Statement.

Item 13.  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions and Director Independence

The information required by this Item 13 is incorporated herein by reference to the sections entitled “Corporate Governance” and “Transactions with Related Parties” in the Company’s Proxy Statement.

Item 14.  Principal Accounting Fees and Services

The information required by this Item 14 is incorporated herein by reference to the section entitled “Audit Fees” in the Company’s Proxy Statement.



 
94

 

Part IV

Item 15.  Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

(a)  Documents filed as part of this report

(1)      All financial statements.  The following consolidated financial statements of Community Bank System, Inc. and subsidiaries are included in Item 8:

-     Consolidated Statements of Condition,
                      December 31, 2014 and 2013

-     Consolidated Statements of Income,
      Years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012
 
-     Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income,
      Years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012
 
-     Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders' Equity,
                      Years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012

-     Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows,
                      Years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012

-     Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,
                      December 31, 2014

-     Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

-     Quarterly selected data,
                      Years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 (unaudited)

(2)      Financial statement schedules.  Schedules are omitted since the required information is either not applicable or shown elsewhere in the financial statements.

(3)      Exhibits.  The exhibits filed as part of this report and exhibits incorporated herein by reference to other documents are listed below:

2.1
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of August 2, 2006, by and among Community Bank System, Inc., Seneca Acquisition Corp. and ONB Corporation.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.2 to the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 8, 2006 (Registration No. 001-13695).
 
 
2.2
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of April 20, 2006, by and among Community Bank System, Inc., ESL Acquisition Corp., and ES&L Bancorp, Inc.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on April 25, 2006 (Registration No. 001-13695).
 
     
2.3
Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of June 24, 2008, by and among RBS Citizens, N.A., Community Bank System, Inc., and Community Bank, N.A.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 26, 2008 (Registration No. 001-13695).
 
     
2.4
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of October 22, 2010, by and among Community Bank System, Inc. and The Wilber Corporation.   Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 25, 2010 (Registration No. 001-13695).
 
     
2.5
Assignment, Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of January 19, 2012, by and among Community Bank, N.A. and First Niagara Bank, N.A.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 20, 2012 (Registration No. 001-13695).
 
     
2.6
Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of January 19, 2012, by and among Community Bank, N.A. and First Niagara Bank, N.A.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 20, 2012 (Registration No. 001-13695).
 
 
 
 
95

 
 
2.7
Assignment, Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of January 19, 2012, by and between Community Bank, N.A. and First Niagara Bank, N.A., as amended as restated as of July 19, 2012.   Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 99.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 24, 2012 (Registration No. 001-13695).
   
2.8
Amendment No. 1 to Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of September 6, 2012, by and among Community Bank, N.A. and First Niagara Bank, N.A. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on September 13, 2012 (Registration No. 001-13695).
   
2.9
Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of July 23, 2013, by and between Community Bank, N.A. and Bank of America, N.A.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 2.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 26, 2013 (Registration No. 001-13695).
   
3.1
Certificate of Incorporation of Community Bank System, Inc., as amended.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 3.1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 filed on October 20, 2000 (Registration No. 333-48374).
   
3.2
Certificate of Amendment of Certificate of Incorporation of Community Bank System, Inc. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 3.1 to the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 7, 2004 (Registration No. 001-13695).
   
3.3
Certificate of Amendment of Certificate of Incorporation of Community Bank System, Inc. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 3.1 to the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 9, 2013 (Registration No. 001-13695).
   
3.4
Bylaws of Community Bank System, Inc., amended July 18, 2007.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 24, 2007 (Registration No. 001-13695).
   
4.1
Form of Common Stock Certificate.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 4.1 to the Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-3 filed on September 29, 2008 (Registration No. 333-153403).
 
10.1
Indenture, dated as of December 8, 2006, between Community Bank System, Inc. and Wilmington Trust Company, as trustee.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 4.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 12, 2006 (Registration No. 001-13695).
   
10.2
Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust, dated as of December 8, 2006, among Community Bank System, Inc., as sponsor, Wilmington Trust Company, as Delaware trustee, Wilmington Trust Company, as institutional trustee, and Mark E. Tryniski, Scott A. Kingsley, and Joseph J. Lemchak as administrators.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 12, 2006 (Registration No. 001-13695).
   
10.3
Guarantee Agreement, dated as of December 8, 2006, between Community Bank System, Inc., as guarantor, and Wilmington Trust Company, as guarantee trustee.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on December 12, 2006 (Registration No. 001-13695).
   
10.4
Employment Agreement, effective January 1, 2015, by and between Community Bank System, Inc., Community Bank, N.A. and Mark E. Tryniski.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 2, 2015 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.5
Supplemental Retirement Plan Agreement, effective as of December 31, 2008, by and among Community Bank, N.A., Community Bank System, Inc. and Mark E. Tryniski.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 19, 2009 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.6
Employment Agreement, dated as of December 31, 2013, by and among Community Bank System, Inc., Community Bank N.A. and Scott Kingsley.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 3, 2014 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
 
 
 
96

 
 
10.7
Supplemental Retirement Plan Agreement, effective September 29, 2009, by and between Community Bank System Inc., Community Bank, N.A., and Scott Kingsley.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 1, 2009 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.8
Employment Agreement, dated as of October 18, 2013, by and between Community Bank System, Inc., Community Bank N.A. and Brian D. Donahue.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 23, 2013 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.9
Supplemental Retirement Plan Agreement, dated as of October 18, 2013, by and between Community Bank System Inc., Community Bank, N.A., and Brian D. Donahue.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 23, 2013 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.10
Employment Agreement, dated as of December 31, 2013, by and among Community Bank System, Inc., Community Bank N.A. and George J. Getman.   Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 3, 2014 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.11
Supplemental Retirement Plan Agreement, dated as of October 18, 2013, by and among Community Bank System, Inc., Community Bank, N.A. and George J. Getman.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 23, 2013 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.12
Employment Agreement, dated as of January 1, 2013, by and among Community Bank System, Inc., Community Bank N.A. and Joseph F. Serbun.   Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.1 to the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 10, 2013 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.13
Pre-2005 Supplemental Retirement Agreement, effective December 31, 2004, by and between Community Bank System, Inc., Community Bank, N.A. and Sanford Belden.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.3 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 15, 2005 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.14
Post-2004 Supplemental Retirement Agreement, effective January 1, 2005, by and between Community Bank System, Inc., Community Bank, N.A. and Sanford Belden.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.2 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 15, 2005 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.15
Supplemental Retirement Plan Agreement, effective March 26, 2003, by and between Community Bank System Inc. and Thomas McCullough.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.11 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 12, 2004 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.16
2004 Long-Term Incentive Compensation Program, as to be amended.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 99.1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-8 filed on December 19, 2012 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.17
2014 Long-Term Incentive Plan.  Incorporated by reference to Appendix A to the Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on April 4, 2014 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.18
Stock Balance Plan for Directors, as amended.  Incorporated by reference to Annex I to the Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on March 31, 1998 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.19
Deferred Compensation Plan for Directors, as amended.  Incorporated by reference to Annex I to the Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on March 31, 1998 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.20
Community Bank System, Inc. Pension Plan Amended and Restated as of January 1, 2004.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.27 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 15, 2005 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
 
 
 
97

 
 
10.21
Amendment #1 to the Community Bank System, Inc. Pension Plan, as amended and restated as of January 1, 2004 (“Plan”).  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.27 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 15, 2005 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.22
Amendment #1 to the Deferred Compensation Plan For Certain Executive Employees of Community Bank System, Inc., as amended and restated as of January 1, 2002.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 10.33 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 15, 2005 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
   
10.23
Community Bank System, Inc. 401(k) Employee Stock Ownership Plan, dated as of December 20, 2011.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 to the Registration Statement on Form S-8 filed on December 20, 2013 (Registration No. 001-13695).(2)
 
14.1
Community Bank System, Inc., Code of Ethics.  Incorporated by reference to Exhibit No. 1 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 15, 2005 (Registration No. 001-13695).
   
21.1
Subsidiaries of Registrant.(1)
   
23.1
Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP.(1)
   
31.1
Certification of Mark E. Tryniski, President and Chief Executive Officer of the Registrant, pursuant to Rule 13a-15(e) or Rule 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.(1)
   
31.2
Certification of Scott Kingsley, Treasurer and Chief Financial Officer of the Registrant, pursuant to Rule 13a-15(e) or Rule 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.(1)
   
32.1
Certification of Mark E. Tryniski, President and Chief Executive Officer of the Registrant, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.(3)
   
32.2
Certification of Scott Kingsley, Treasurer and Chief Financial Officer of the Registrant, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.(3)
   
101
Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) the Consolidated Statements of Condition, (ii) the Consolidated Statements of Income, (iii) the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income, (iv) the Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity, (v) the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, and (vi) the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements tagged as blocks of text and in detail.(4)

(1) Filed herewith.
(2) Denotes management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.
(3) Furnished herewith.
(4) XBRL (Extensible Business Reporting Language) information is furnished and not filed or a part of a registration statement or prospectus for purposes of sections 11 or 12 of the Securities Act
      of 1933, is deemed not filed for purposes of section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and otherwise is not subject to liability under these sections.
 
B.      Not applicable


C.      Not applicable.

 
98

 

SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

COMMUNITY BANK SYSTEM, INC.


By:
/s/ Mark E. Tryniski
Mark E. Tryniski
President and Chief Executive Officer
March 2, 2015

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities indicated on the 2nd day of March 2015.


By:
/s/ Mark E. Tryniski
Mark E. Tryniski
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
 
By:
/s/ Scott Kingsley
Scott Kingsley
Treasurer and Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer and Principal Accounting Officer)


Directors:
 

/s/ Brian R. Ace
/s/ Edward S. Mucenski
Brian R. Ace, Director
Edward S. Mucenski, Director
   
/s/ Mark J. Bolus
/s/ John Parente
Mark J. Bolus, Director
John Parente, Director
   
/s/ Nicholas A. DiCerbo
/s/ Sally A. Steele
Nicholas A. DiCerbo, Director and Chairman of the
Board of Directors
Sally A. Steele, Director
   
/s/ Neil E. Fesette
/s/ John F. Whipple, Jr.
Neil E. Fesette, Director
John F. Whipple Jr., Director
   
/s/ James A. Gabriel
/s/ James A. Wilson
James A. Gabriel, Director
James A. Wilson, Director
   
/s/ James W. Gibson, Jr.
 
James W. Gibson, Jr., Director
 
 
 
 
 
 
99